drivers: xds110: Add support for XDS110 stand-alone probe
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
34 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
35 Free Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * TFTP:: TFTP
83 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
84 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
85 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
86 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
87 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
88
89 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
90 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
91 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
92 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
93 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
94 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
95 @end menu
96
97 @node About
98 @unnumbered About
99 @cindex about
100
101 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
102 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
103 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
104 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
105 around the world.
106
107 @section What is OpenOCD?
108 @cindex TAP
109 @cindex JTAG
110
111 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
112 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
113 devices.
114
115 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
116 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
117 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
118 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
119 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
120 needed to hook up to the target.
121
122 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
123 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
124 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
125 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
126 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
127
128 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
129 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
130 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
131 let the development board connect directly to the debug
132 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
133
134 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
135 signaling, and is used to communicate
136 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
137 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
138 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
139 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
140 scan operations.
141
142 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
143 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
144 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
145 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
146
147 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
148 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
149 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
150 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
151
152
153 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
154 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
155 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
156
157 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
158 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
159 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
160 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
161
162 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
163 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
164 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
165 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
166 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
167
168 @section OpenOCD Web Site
169
170 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
171
172 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
173
174 @section Latest User's Guide:
175
176 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
177 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
178 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
179
180 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
181
182 PDF form is likewise published at:
183
184 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
185
186 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
187
188 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
189 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
190 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
191 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
192 instead of this forum.
193
194 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
195
196 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
197
198 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
199 communication between users:
200
201 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
202
203 @section OpenOCD IRC
204
205 Support can also be found on irc:
206 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
207
208 @node Developers
209 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
210 @cindex developers
211
212 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
213 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
214 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
215 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
216
217 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
218 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
219
220 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
221
222 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
223 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
224
225 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
226
227 or via http
228
229 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
230
231 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
232
233 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
234
235 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
236 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
237 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
238 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
239 needing a Git client:
240
241 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
242
243 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
244 from the repository or a snapshot.
245
246 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
247 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
248 Patches created against older versions may require additional
249 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
250
251 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
252
253 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
254 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
255 technical information about the software internals, development
256 processes, and similar documentation:
257
258 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
259
260 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
261 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
262 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
263
264 @section Gerrit Review System
265
266 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
267 Code Review System:
268
269 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
270
271 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
272 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
273 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
274 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
275 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
276
277 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
278 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
279 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
280 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
281 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
282
283 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
284
285 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
286 communication between developers:
287
288 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
289
290 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
291
292 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
293
294 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
295
296
297 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
299 @cindex dongles
300 @cindex FTDI
301 @cindex wiggler
302 @cindex zy1000
303 @cindex printer port
304 @cindex USB Adapter
305 @cindex RTCK
306
307 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
308 an adapter .... [snip]
309
310 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
311 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port. One
312 exception is the Ultimate Solutions ZY1000, packaged as a small box you
313 attach via an ethernet cable. The ZY1000 has the advantage that it does not
314 require any drivers to be installed on the developer PC. It also has
315 a built in web interface. It supports RTCK/RCLK or adaptive clocking
316 and has a built-in relay to power cycle targets remotely.
317
318
319 @section Choosing a Dongle
320
321 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
322
323 @enumerate
324 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
325 OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
326 other ways to communicate with target devices.
327 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
328 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
329 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
330 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
331 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
332 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
333 Ethernet port needed?
334 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
335 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
336 @end enumerate
337
338 @section Stand-alone JTAG Probe
339
340 The ZY1000 from Ultimate Solutions is technically not a dongle but a
341 stand-alone JTAG probe that, unlike most dongles, doesn't require any drivers
342 running on the developer's host computer.
343 Once installed on a network using DHCP or a static IP assignment, users can
344 access the ZY1000 probe locally or remotely from any host with access to the
345 IP address assigned to the probe.
346 The ZY1000 provides an intuitive web interface with direct access to the
347 OpenOCD debugger.
348 Users may also run a GDBSERVER directly on the ZY1000 to take full advantage
349 of GCC & GDB to debug any distribution of embedded Linux or NetBSD running on
350 the target.
351 The ZY1000 supports RTCK & RCLK or adaptive clocking and has a built-in relay
352 to power cycle the target remotely.
353
354 For more information, visit:
355
356 @b{ZY1000} See: @url{http://www.ultsol.com/index.php/component/content/article/8/210-zylin-zy1000-main}
357
358 @section USB FT2232 Based
359
360 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
361 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
362 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
363 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
364 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
365 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
366 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
367 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
368 clocking.)
369
370 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
371 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
372 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
373 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
374 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
375
376 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
377 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
378
379 @itemize @bullet
380 @item @b{usbjtag}
381 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
382 @item @b{jtagkey}
383 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
384 @item @b{jtagkey2}
385 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
386 @item @b{oocdlink}
387 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
388 @item @b{signalyzer}
389 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
390 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
391 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
392 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
393 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
394 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
395 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
396 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
397 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
398 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
399 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
400 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
401 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
402 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
403 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
404 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
405 @item @b{turtelizer2}
406 @* See:
407 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
408 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
409 @item @b{comstick}
410 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
411 @item @b{stm32stick}
412 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
413 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
414 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
415 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
416 @item @b{cortino}
417 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
418 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
419 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
420 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
421 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
422 @item @b{opendous}
423 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
424 (OpenHardware).
425 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
426 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
427
428 @item @b{GW16042}
429 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
430 FT2232H-based
431
432 @end itemize
433 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
434
435 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
436 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
437 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
438 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
439 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
440
441 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
442 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
443 (see the section on driver commands).
444
445 @itemize
446 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
447 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
448 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB J-Link based
453 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
454 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
455 AT91SAM764 internally.
456
457 @itemize @bullet
458 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
460 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
461 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
462 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
463 @end itemize
464
465 @section USB RLINK based
466 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
467 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
468 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
469
470 @itemize @bullet
471 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
472 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
473 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
474 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
475 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
476 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
477 @end itemize
478
479 @section USB ST-LINK based
480 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
481 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
482
483 @itemize @bullet
484 @item @b{ST-LINK}
485 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
486 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
487 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
488 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
489 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
490 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
491 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
492 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
493 @end itemize
494
495 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
496 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
497 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
498 @itemize @bullet
499 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
500 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
501 @end itemize
502
503 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
504 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
505 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
506 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
507
508 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
509 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
510 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
511
512 @section USB Other
513 @itemize @bullet
514 @item @b{USBprog}
515 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
516
517 @item @b{USB - Presto}
518 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
519
520 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
521 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
522
523 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
524 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
525
526 @item @b{Buspirate}
527 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
528
529 @item @b{opendous}
530 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
531
532 @item @b{estick}
533 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
534
535 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
536 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
537
538 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
539 @* The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
540 LaunchPad evaluation boards.
541 @* The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB debug probe. The XDS110
542 stand-alone probe has the additional ability to supply voltage to the target
543 board via its AUX FUNCTIONS port. Use the
544 @command{xds110_supply_voltage <millivolts>} command to set the voltage. 0 turns
545 off the supply. Otherwise, the supply can be set to any value in the range 1800
546 to 3600 millivolts.
547 @* Link: @url{http://processors.wiki.ti.com/index.php/XDS110}
548 @* Link: @url{http://processors.wiki.ti.com/index.php/XDS_Emulation_Software_Package#XDS110_Support_Utilities}
549 @end itemize
550
551 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
552
553 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
554 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
555 these on the market.
556
557 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
558 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
559 of USB-based ones.
560
561 @itemize @bullet
562
563 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
564 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
565
566 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
567 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
568 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
569
570 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
571 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
572
573 @item @b{Wiggler2}
574 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
575
576 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
577 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
578
579 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
580 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
581
582 @item @b{arm-jtag}
583 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
584
585 @item @b{chameleon}
586 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
587
588 @item @b{Triton}
589 @* Unknown.
590
591 @item @b{Lattice}
592 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
593 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
594
595 @item @b{flashlink}
596 @* From STMicroelectronics;
597 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
598
599 @end itemize
600
601 @section Other...
602 @itemize @bullet
603
604 @item @b{ep93xx}
605 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
606
607 @item @b{at91rm9200}
608 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
609
610 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
611 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
612
613 @item @b{imx_gpio}
614 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
615
616 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
617 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
618 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
619
620 @end itemize
621
622 @node About Jim-Tcl
623 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
624 @cindex Jim-Tcl
625 @cindex tcl
626
627 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
628 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
629 command interpreter.
630
631 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
632 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
633 much of anything about Tcl.
634 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
635
636 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
637 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
638 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
639 OpenOCD mailing list.
640
641 @itemize @bullet
642 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
643 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
644 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
645 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
646 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
647 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
648
649 @item @b{Missing Features}
650 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
651 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
652 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
653 enabled in OpenOCD.
654
655 @item @b{Scripts}
656 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
657 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
658 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
659
660 @item @b{Commands}
661 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
662 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
663 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
664 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
665
666 @item @b{Historical Note}
667 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
668 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
669 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
670 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
671
672 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
673 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
674 @end itemize
675
676 @node Running
677 @chapter Running
678 @cindex command line options
679 @cindex logfile
680 @cindex directory search
681
682 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
683 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
684 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
685 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
686 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
687 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
688 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
689
690 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
691 tell it how each debug session should work.
692 The @option{--help} option shows:
693 @verbatim
694 bash$ openocd --help
695
696 --help | -h display this help
697 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
698 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
699 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
700 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
701 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
702 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
703 --command | -c run <command>
704 @end verbatim
705
706 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
707 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
708 To specify one or more different
709 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
710
711 @example
712 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
713 @end example
714
715 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
716 @enumerate
717 @item the current directory,
718 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
719 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
720 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd} (not on Windows),
721 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
722 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
723 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
724 @end enumerate
725 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
726
727 @quotation Note
728 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
729 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
730 @end quotation
731
732 @section Simple setup, no customization
733
734 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
735 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
736 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
737 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
738 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
739
740 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
741 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
742 the server with some variation of one of the following:
743
744 @example
745 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
746 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
747 @end example
748
749 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
750 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
751 If all goes well you'll see output something like
752
753 @example
754 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
755 For bug reports, read
756 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
757 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
758 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
759 @end example
760
761 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
762 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
763 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
764
765 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
766
767 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
768 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
769 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
770 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
771 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
772 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
773 ensure that this always succeeds.
774 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
775 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
776 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
777 and then shut down without acting as a server.
778
779 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
780 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
781 those channels.
782
783 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
784 the @option{-d} option.
785
786 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
787 @option{-c} command line switch.
788
789 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
790 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
791 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
792 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
793 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
794 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
795 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
796
797 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
798 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
799
800 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
801 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
802 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
803 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
804
805 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
806 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
807
808 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
809 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
810 and start the OpenOCD server.
811 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
812 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
813 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
814 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
815
816 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
817
818 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
819 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
820 and a USB cable on the other.
821 Instead of USB, some cables use Ethernet;
822 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
823
824 @enumerate
825 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
826 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
827 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
828 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
829 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
830 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
831 debugging host.
832
833 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
834 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
835 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
836 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
837 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
838
839 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
840 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
841 with 1.2 Volt boards.
842
843 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
844 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
845 ways to connect the cable.
846 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
847 Be sure it's firmly connected.
848
849 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
850 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
851 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
852 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
853 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
854 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
855 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
856 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
857
858 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
859 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
860 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
861 but are tedious to set up.
862 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
863 adapter signals to the right board pins.
864
865 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
866 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
867 you are using to run OpenOCD.
868 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
869
870 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
871 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
872 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
873 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
874
875 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
876 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
877 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
878
879 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
880 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
881 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
882 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
883
884 @end enumerate
885
886 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
887 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
888 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
889
890 @section Project Directory
891
892 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
893
894 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
895 single directory for your work with a given board.
896 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
897 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
898 files accessed through semihosting,
899 and for code you upload to the target board.
900 It is also the natural place to write files,
901 such as log files and data you download from the board.
902
903 @section Configuration Basics
904
905 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
906 a variety of ways you can mix them.
907 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
908
909 @itemize
910 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
911 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
912 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
913 @end itemize
914
915 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
916 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
917 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
918
919 @example
920 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
921
922 # GDB can also flash my flash!
923 gdb_memory_map enable
924 gdb_flash_program enable
925
926 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
927 @end example
928
929 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
930
931 @example
932 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
933 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
934 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
935 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
936 @end example
937
938 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
939 each supporting a different development task.
940 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
941 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
942
943 @quotation Important
944 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
945 problems with how it treats variables.
946 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
947 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
948 that can be tested in a later script.
949 @end quotation
950
951 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
952 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
953 to simplify your work.
954
955 @section User Config Files
956 @cindex config file, user
957 @cindex user config file
958 @cindex config file, overview
959
960 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
961 in one place.
962 One of the following will match your situation best:
963
964 @itemize
965 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
966 provided by someone else.
967 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
968 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
969 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
970 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
971 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
972 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
973
974 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
975 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
976
977 @enumerate
978 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
979 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
980 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
981 @end enumerate
982
983 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
984 The first is an interface config file.
985 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
986 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
987 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
988 meet your deadline:
989
990 @example
991 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
992 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
993 @end example
994
995 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
996 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
997 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
998 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
999
1000 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
1001 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
1002 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
1003 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
1004 target and board
1005 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
1006 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
1007
1008 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
1009 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1010 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1011 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1012
1013 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1014 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1015 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1016 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1017 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1018
1019 @quotation Note
1020 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1021 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1022 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1023 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1024 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1025 @end quotation
1026
1027 @item
1028 You may may need to write some C code.
1029 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1030 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1031 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1032 a new chip architecture.
1033 @end itemize
1034
1035 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1036 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1037 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1038
1039 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1040 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1041 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1042 @itemize
1043
1044 @item
1045 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1046 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1047 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1048 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1049
1050 @item
1051 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1052 @cindex vector_catch
1053 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1054 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1055 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1056 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1057 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1058 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1059
1060 @item
1061 You might need to override some defaults.
1062 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1063 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1064
1065 @item
1066 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1067 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1068 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1069 @end itemize
1070
1071 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1072
1073 A few project-specific utility
1074 routines may well speed up your work.
1075 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1076
1077 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1078 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1079 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1080 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1081 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1082 may help:
1083
1084 @example
1085 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1086 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1087 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1088 # Leave the CPU halted.
1089 reset init
1090
1091 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1092 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1093
1094 # Start running.
1095 resume 0x20000000
1096 @}
1097 @end example
1098
1099 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1100 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1101 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1102 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1103 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1104
1105 @example
1106 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1107 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1108 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1109 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1110 reset init
1111
1112 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1113 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1114 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1115 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1116 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1117 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1118 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1119
1120 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1121 reset run
1122 @}
1123 @end example
1124
1125 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1126 from NAND.
1127 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1128 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1129 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1130
1131 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1132 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1133
1134 @section Target Software Changes
1135
1136 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1137 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1138 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1139 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1140 handling issues like:
1141
1142 @itemize @bullet
1143
1144 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1145 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1146 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1147 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1148 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1149 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1150 your debug sessions.
1151
1152 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1153 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1154 That might however be your only option.
1155
1156 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1157 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1158 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1159 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1160 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1161 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1162 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1163 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1164 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1165 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1166 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1167 instead of the whole thing.
1168 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1169 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1170
1171 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1172 @cindex ARM semihosting
1173 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1174 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1175 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1176 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1177 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1178 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1179 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1180 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1181 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1182 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1183 NAND or SPI flash.
1184
1185 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1186 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1187 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1188 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1189 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1190
1191 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1192 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1193 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1194 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1195 registers which can be used to change various features including
1196 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1197 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1198 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1199 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1200 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1201
1202 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1203 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1204 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1205 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1206 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1207
1208 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1209 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1210 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1211 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1212 early code execution can be debugged
1213 or firmware can be replaced.
1214
1215 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1216 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1217 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1218 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1219 operations like writing to memory.)
1220
1221 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1222 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1223 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1224 various kinds of message.
1225 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1226
1227 @end itemize
1228
1229 @section Target Hardware Setup
1230
1231 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1232 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1233 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1234 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1235 working with.}
1236
1237 Common issues include:
1238
1239 @itemize @bullet
1240
1241 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1242 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1243 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1244 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1245 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1246 or one from a daughtercard).
1247 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1248 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1249
1250 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1251 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1252 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1253 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1254 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1255 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1256
1257 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1258 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1259 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1260 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1261 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1262
1263
1264 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1265 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1266 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1267 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1268 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1269 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1270 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1271
1272 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1273 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1274 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1275 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1276 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1277
1278 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1279 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1280 used to start booting.
1281
1282 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1283 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1284 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1285 multiple audio codec chips).
1286 This interacts with software
1287 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1288 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1289 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1290 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1291 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1292 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1293 audio or video codecs are used.
1294
1295 @end itemize
1296
1297 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1298 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1299 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1300 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1301 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1302 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1303 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1304 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1305 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1306 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1307
1308
1309 @node Config File Guidelines
1310 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1311
1312 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1313 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1314 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1315 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1316
1317 You should find the following directories under
1318 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1319 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1320 @itemize @bullet
1321 @item @file{interface} ...
1322 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1323 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1324 @item @file{board} ...
1325 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1326 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1327
1328 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1329 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1330 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1331 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1332 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1333 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1334 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1335 a CPU and an FPGA.
1336 @item @file{target} ...
1337 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1338 on a chip
1339 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1340 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1341 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1342 the target config file defines all of them.
1343 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1344 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1345 @end itemize
1346
1347 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1348 file may override features in any of the above files by
1349 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1350 commands specific to their situation.
1351
1352 @section Interface Config Files
1353
1354 The user config file
1355 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1356
1357 @example
1358 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1359 @end example
1360
1361 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1362 in use today with OpenOCD.
1363 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1364 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1365
1366 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1367 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1368 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1369 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1370 and need to provide a driver for it.
1371
1372 @section Board Config Files
1373 @cindex config file, board
1374 @cindex board config file
1375
1376 The user config file
1377 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1378
1379 @example
1380 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1381 @end example
1382
1383 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1384 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1385 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1386
1387 @enumerate
1388 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1389 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1390 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1391 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1392 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1393 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1394 @end enumerate
1395
1396 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1397 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1398 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1399 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1400
1401 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1402 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1403 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1404 configuration works.
1405
1406 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1407
1408 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1409 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1410 convention on how to use certain variables.
1411
1412 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1413 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1414 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1415 used at will within a target configuration file.
1416
1417 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1418 for a board with three chips:
1419
1420 @example
1421 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1422 set CHIPNAME network
1423 set ENDIAN big
1424 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1425 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1426 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1427 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1428
1429 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1430 set CHIPNAME video
1431 set ENDIAN little
1432 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1433 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1434 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1435 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1436
1437 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1438 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1439 unset ENDIAN
1440 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1441 @end example
1442
1443 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1444 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1445 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1446 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1447 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1448 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1449 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1450 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1451
1452 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1453 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1454 naming collisions.
1455
1456 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1457 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1458 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1459 up other clocks and peripherals.
1460
1461 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1462 @cindex variable names
1463
1464 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1465 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1466 one such chip (as shown above).
1467 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1468 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1469 to promote consistency and
1470 so that board files can override target defaults.
1471
1472 Inputs to target config files include:
1473
1474 @itemize @bullet
1475 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1476 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1477 tap identifier dotted names.
1478 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1479 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1480 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1481 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1482 Chips that can't change endianess don't need to use this variable.
1483 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1484 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1485 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1486 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1487 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1488 @end itemize
1489
1490 Outputs from target config files include:
1491
1492 @itemize @bullet
1493 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1494 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1495 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1496 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1497 specific to that board and that target.
1498 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1499 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1500 @end itemize
1501
1502 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1503 @cindex event, reset-init
1504 @cindex reset-init handler
1505
1506 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1507 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1508 fully set up yet.
1509 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1510 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1511 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1512 handler is one of the most important.
1513
1514 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1515 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1516 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1517 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1518 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1519
1520 @quotation Note
1521 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1522 are included here.
1523 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1524 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1525 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1526 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1527 @end quotation
1528
1529 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1530 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1531 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1532 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1533 those as parameters.
1534 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1535 and disabling the watchdog.
1536 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1537 the next developer doing such work.
1538 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1539
1540 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1541 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1542 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1543 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1544
1545 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1546
1547 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1548 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1549 a low JTAG clock rate.
1550 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1551 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1552 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1553 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1554 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1555 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1556 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1557
1558 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1559 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1560 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1561 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1562 which might be less than that.
1563
1564 @quotation Warning
1565 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1566 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1567 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1568 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1569 @end quotation
1570
1571 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1572 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1573 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1574 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter_khz}.
1575 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1576 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1577
1578 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1579 @subsection The init_board procedure
1580 @cindex init_board procedure
1581
1582 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1583 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1584 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1585 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1586 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1587 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1588 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1589 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1590 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1591 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1592 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1593 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1594
1595 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1596 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1597
1598 @example
1599 ### board_file.cfg ###
1600
1601 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1602 source [find target/target.cfg]
1603
1604 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1605 # enables fast on-board clock source
1606 # configures the chip to use it
1607 @}
1608
1609 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1610 proc init_board @{@} @{
1611 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1612
1613 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1614 adapter_khz 100
1615 @}
1616
1617 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1618 enable_fast_clock
1619 adapter_khz 10000
1620 @}
1621 @}
1622 @end example
1623
1624 @section Target Config Files
1625 @cindex config file, target
1626 @cindex target config file
1627
1628 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1629 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1630 more target config files like this:
1631
1632 @example
1633 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1634 @end example
1635
1636 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1637 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1638 In summary the target files should contain
1639
1640 @enumerate
1641 @item Set defaults
1642 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1643 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1644 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1645 @item On-Chip flash
1646 @end enumerate
1647
1648 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1649 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1650 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1651
1652 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1653 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1654 can talk to the chip.
1655 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1656 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1657 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1658 and other processing engines.
1659
1660 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1661
1662 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1663 letting board config files express environment-specific
1664 differences in how things should be set up.
1665
1666 @example
1667 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1668 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1669 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1670 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1671 @} else @{
1672 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1673 @}
1674
1675 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1676 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1677 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1678 @} else @{
1679 set _ENDIAN little
1680 @}
1681
1682 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1683 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1684 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1685 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1686 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1687 @} else @{
1688 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1689 @}
1690 @end example
1691 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1692
1693 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1694 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1695 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1696
1697 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1698 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1699 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1700
1701 @example
1702 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1703 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1704 @end example
1705
1706 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1707 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1708 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1709 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1710 for taps.
1711
1712 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1713 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1714 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1715 looks (in part) like this:
1716
1717 @example
1718 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1719 @end example
1720
1721 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1722 to source such a config file twice, with different
1723 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1724 it adds a different TAP each time.
1725
1726 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1727 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1728 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1729 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1730
1731 @example
1732 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1733 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1734 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1735 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1736 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1737 @end example
1738
1739 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1740 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1741
1742 @itemize
1743 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1744 plus a JRC to enable them
1745 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1746 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1747 is not currently used)
1748 @end itemize
1749
1750 @subsection Add CPU targets
1751
1752 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1753 GDB and other commands can use it.
1754 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1755 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1756 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1757 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1758
1759 @example
1760 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1761 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1762 @end example
1763
1764 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1765 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1766 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1767 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1768 a work area if you can.
1769 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1770
1771 @example
1772 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1773 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1774 @end example
1775
1776 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1777 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1778 @cindex SMP
1779 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1780
1781 @example
1782 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1783 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1784 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1785 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1786 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1787 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1788 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1789 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1790 @end example
1791 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1792 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1793 @itemize @bullet
1794 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1795 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1796 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1797 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1798 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1799 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1800 @end itemize
1801
1802 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1803 command have been implemented.
1804 @itemize @bullet
1805 @item cortex_a smp_on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1806 @item cortex_a smp_off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1807 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1808 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1809 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1810 following example.
1811 @end itemize
1812
1813 @example
1814 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1815 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1816 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1817 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1818 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1819 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1820 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1821 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1822 > resume
1823 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1824 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1825 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1826 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1827 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1828 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1829 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1830 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1831 @end example
1832
1833
1834 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1835
1836 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1837 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1838 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1839
1840 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1841 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1842 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1843 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1844 both signals.
1845
1846 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1847 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1848 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1849 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1850 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1851 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1852 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1853 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1854 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1855 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1856 not available.)
1857
1858 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1859 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1860 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1861 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1862 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1863 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1864 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1865 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1866
1867 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1868 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1869 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1870 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1871 slower clock than they will use later.
1872 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1873 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1874 than they will use later.
1875 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1876
1877 @quotation Important
1878 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1879 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1880 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1881 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1882 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1883 @end quotation
1884
1885 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1886 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1887 @cindex init_targets procedure
1888
1889 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1890 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1891 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1892 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1893 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1894 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1895 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1896 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1897 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1898
1899 @example
1900 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1901
1902 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1903 # basic initialization procedure ...
1904 @}
1905
1906 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1907 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1908 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1909 @}
1910
1911 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1912
1913 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1914
1915 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1916 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1917 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1918 @}
1919 @end example
1920
1921 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1922 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1923
1924 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1925
1926 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1927 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1928
1929 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1930 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1931 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1932
1933 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1934 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1935 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1936 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1937 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1938 events already assigned.
1939
1940 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1941
1942 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1943 special high speed download features - enable it.
1944
1945 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1946
1947 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1948 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1949 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1950 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1951 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1952 If you are using an external trace port,
1953 configure it in your board config file.
1954 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1955 configure it in your target config file.
1956
1957 @example
1958 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1959 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1960 @end example
1961
1962 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1963
1964 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1965
1966 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1967 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1968 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1969 the TARGET (chip) file.
1970
1971 Examples:
1972 @itemize @bullet
1973 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1974 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1975 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1976 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1977 @end itemize
1978
1979 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1980 @section Translating Configuration Files
1981 @cindex translation
1982 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1983 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1984 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1985 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1986 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1987 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1988
1989 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1990 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1991 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1992 convert other scripts later on.
1993
1994 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1995 replace job:
1996
1997 @example
1998 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
1999 #
2000 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
2001 #
2002 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
2003 #
2004 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
2005
2006 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
2007 global TARGETNAME
2008
2009 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2010
2011 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
2012 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
2013 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
2014 @}
2015 @end example
2016
2017
2018
2019 @node Server Configuration
2020 @chapter Server Configuration
2021 @cindex initialization
2022 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2023 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2024 supported.
2025
2026 @anchor{configurationstage}
2027 @section Configuration Stage
2028 @cindex configuration stage
2029 @cindex config command
2030
2031 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2032 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2033 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2034 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2035 inside startup scripts.
2036
2037 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2038 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2039 which may be issued interactively.
2040 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2041 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2042
2043 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2044 flash banks,
2045 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2046 and other basic setup.
2047 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2048 may access or activate TAPs.
2049 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2050 longer be issued.
2051
2052 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2053 @section Entering the Run Stage
2054
2055 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2056 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2057 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2058 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2059 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2060 You should see no errors at this point.
2061 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2062 commands you used to configure the server.
2063 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2064 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2065 on the scan chain.
2066
2067 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2068 become available.
2069 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2070 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2071 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2072 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2073 entry to the run stage.
2074
2075 @deffn {Config Command} init
2076 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2077 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2078 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2079 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2080 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2081 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2082
2083 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2084 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2085 configuration files and/or command line options.
2086
2087 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2088 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2089 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2090 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2091 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2092 @end deffn
2093
2094 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} jtag_init
2095 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2096 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2097
2098 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2099 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2100 scan chain.
2101 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2102 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2103
2104 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2105 they return.
2106 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2107 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2108 @end deffn
2109
2110 @anchor{tcpipports}
2111 @section TCP/IP Ports
2112 @cindex TCP port
2113 @cindex server
2114 @cindex port
2115 @cindex security
2116 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2117 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2118 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2119
2120 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2121 access using one or more of these ports.
2122 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2123 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2124 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2125
2126 @anchor{gdb_port}
2127 @deffn {Command} gdb_port [number]
2128 @cindex GDB server
2129 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2130 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2131 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2132 the normal use cases.
2133
2134 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2135 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2136 disables the gdb server.
2137
2138 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2139 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2140
2141 The -p/--pipe option is deprecated and a warning is printed
2142 as it is equivalent to passing in -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log".
2143
2144 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2145 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2146 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2147
2148 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2149 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2150 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2151 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2152 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2153 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2154 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2155 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2156 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2157
2158 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2159 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2160 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2161 @end deffn
2162
2163 @deffn {Command} tcl_port [number]
2164 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2165 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2166 output from the Tcl engine.
2167 Intended as a machine interface.
2168 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2169 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2170 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2171 @end deffn
2172
2173 @deffn {Command} telnet_port [number]
2174 Specify or query the
2175 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2176 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2177 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2178 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2179 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2180 @end deffn
2181
2182 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2183 @section GDB Configuration
2184 @cindex GDB
2185 @cindex GDB configuration
2186 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2187 The ones listed here are static and global.
2188 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2189 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2190
2191 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2192 @deffn {Command} gdb_breakpoint_override [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2193 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2194 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2195 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2196 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2197 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2198 @end deffn
2199
2200 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2201 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_flash_program (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2202 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2203 vFlash packet is received.
2204 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2205 @end deffn
2206
2207 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_memory_map (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2208 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2209 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2210 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2211 for flash programming to work.
2212 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2213 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2214 @end deffn
2215
2216 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_data_abort (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2217 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2218 by GDB memory read packets.
2219 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2220 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2221 @end deffn
2222
2223 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_register_access_error (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2224 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2225 packets report errors or not.
2226 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2227 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2228 @end deffn
2229
2230 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_target_description (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2231 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2232 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2233 @end deffn
2234
2235 @deffn {Command} gdb_save_tdesc
2236 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2237
2238 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2239 @end deffn
2240
2241 @anchor{eventpolling}
2242 @section Event Polling
2243
2244 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2245 where significant events can happen at any time.
2246 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2247 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2248 or to GDB.
2249
2250 Examples of such events include:
2251
2252 @itemize
2253 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2254 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2255 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2256 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2257 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2258 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2259 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2260 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2261 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2262 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2263 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2264 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2265 @end itemize
2266
2267 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2268 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2269 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2270 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2271 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2272
2273 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2274 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2275 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2276 to the various active targets.
2277 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2278 which is normally done in the background.
2279
2280 @deffn Command poll [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2281 Poll the current target for its current state.
2282 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2283 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2284 specific information about the current state is printed.
2285 An optional parameter
2286 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2287
2288 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2289 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2290 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2291 @example
2292 > poll
2293 background polling: on
2294 target state: halted
2295 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2296 current mode: Supervisor
2297 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2298 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2299 >
2300 @end example
2301 @end deffn
2302
2303 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2304 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2305 @cindex config file, interface
2306 @cindex interface config file
2307
2308 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2309 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2310 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2311
2312 @quotation Note
2313 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2314 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2315 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2316 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2317 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2318 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2319 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2320 @end quotation
2321
2322 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2323 through commands in an interface configuration
2324 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2325 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2326
2327 @example
2328 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2329 @end example
2330
2331 These commands tell
2332 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2333 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2334
2335 @example
2336 # jlink interface
2337 interface jlink
2338 @end example
2339
2340 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2341
2342
2343 @section Interface Configuration
2344
2345 The interface command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2346 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2347 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2348
2349 @deffn {Config Command} {interface} name
2350 Use the interface driver @var{name} to connect to the
2351 target.
2352 @end deffn
2353
2354 @deffn Command {interface_list}
2355 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2356 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2357 @end deffn
2358 @deffn Command {interface transports} transport_name+
2359 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2360 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2361 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2362 the hardware can support.
2363 @end deffn
2364
2365
2366
2367 @deffn Command {adapter_name}
2368 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2369 @end deffn
2370
2371 @section Interface Drivers
2372
2373 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2374 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2375 available at run time.
2376
2377 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2378 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2379 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2380 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2381
2382 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2383 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2384 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2385 @end deffn
2386
2387 @deffn {Config Command} rtck [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2388 Displays status of RTCK option.
2389 Optionally sets that option first.
2390 @end deffn
2391 @end deffn
2392
2393 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2394 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2395 This has one driver-specific command:
2396
2397 @deffn Command {armjtagew_info}
2398 Logs some status
2399 @end deffn
2400 @end deffn
2401
2402 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2403 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2404 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2405 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2406 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2407 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2408 @end deffn
2409
2410 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2411 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter.
2412
2413 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2414 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2415 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2416 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2417 @example
2418 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2419 @end example
2420 @end deffn
2421
2422 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2423 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2424 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2425 @end deffn
2426
2427 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2428 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2429 @end deffn
2430 @end deffn
2431
2432 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2433 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2434 @end deffn
2435
2436 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2437 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2438 @end deffn
2439
2440 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2441 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2442 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2443
2444 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2445 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi or D2XX.
2446
2447 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2448 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2449
2450 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2451 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2452 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2453 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2454 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2455 @command{ftdi_get_signal} command.
2456
2457 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2458 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2459 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2460 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2461 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2462
2463 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2464 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2465 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2466 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2467
2468 @itemize @minus
2469 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2470 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2471 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2472 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2473 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2474 switching data and direction as necessary
2475 @end itemize
2476
2477 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2478 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2479
2480 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2481 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2482 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2483 @example
2484 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2485 @end example
2486 @end deffn
2487
2488 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2489 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2490 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2491 during device selection.
2492 @end deffn
2493
2494 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2495 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2496 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2497 is connected to the host.
2498 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2499 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2500 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2501 @end deffn
2502
2503 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_location} <bus>:<port>[,<port>]...
2504 Specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2505 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2506 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2507 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2508 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t}.
2509
2510 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2511 @end deffn
2512
2513 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2514 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2515 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2516 @end deffn
2517
2518 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2519 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2520 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2521 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2522 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2523 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2524 and initially asserted reset signals.
2525 @end deffn
2526
2527 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2528 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2529 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2530 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2531 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2532 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2533 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2534 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2535 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2536 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2537 with the method @command{ftdi_get_signal}.
2538
2539 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2540 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2541 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2542 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2543 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2544 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2545
2546 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2547 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2548 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2549 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2550 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2551 are always driven by the FTDI.
2552
2553 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2554 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2555 @var{name}.
2556 @end deffn
2557
2558 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2559 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2560 @itemize @minus
2561 @item @option{0}, drive low
2562 @item @option{1}, drive high
2563 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2564 @end itemize
2565 @end deffn
2566
2567 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_get_signal} name
2568 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2569 @end deffn
2570
2571 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2572 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2573
2574 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2575 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2576 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2577 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2578 @itemize @minus
2579 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2580 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2581 @end itemize
2582 @end deffn
2583
2584 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2585 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2586
2587 @end deffn
2588
2589 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2590 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2591 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2592 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2593
2594 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2595 @itemize @minus
2596 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2597 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2598 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2599 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2600 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2601 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2602 @end itemize
2603
2604 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2605 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2606 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2607 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2608 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2609 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2610 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2611 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2612
2613 FT232R
2614 @itemize @minus
2615 @item bit 7 - RI
2616 @item bit 6 - DCD
2617 @item bit 5 - DSR
2618 @item bit 4 - DTR
2619 @item bit 3 - CTS
2620 @item bit 2 - RTS
2621 @item bit 1 - RXD
2622 @item bit 0 - TXD
2623 @end itemize
2624
2625 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2626 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2627
2628 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2629 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2630 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2631 @end deffn
2632
2633 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_serial_desc} @var{serial}
2634 Specifies the @var{serial} of the adapter to use, in case the
2635 vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter is connected to
2636 the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2637 @end deffn
2638
2639 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2640 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2641 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2642 @end deffn
2643
2644 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tck_num} @var{tck}
2645 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2646 @end deffn
2647
2648 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tms_num} @var{tms}
2649 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2650 @end deffn
2651
2652 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2653 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2654 @end deffn
2655
2656 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2657 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2658 @end deffn
2659
2660 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_trst_num} @var{trst}
2661 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2662 @end deffn
2663
2664 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_srst_num} @var{srst}
2665 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2666 @end deffn
2667
2668 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_restore_serial} @var{word}
2669 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2670 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2671 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2672 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2673 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2674 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2675 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2676 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2677 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2678 @end deffn
2679
2680 @end deffn
2681
2682 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2683 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2684 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2685 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2686
2687 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2688 processors which are being simulated.
2689
2690 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2691 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2692 sockets instead of TCP.
2693 @end deffn
2694
2695 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2696 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2697 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2698 @end deffn
2699
2700 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2701 something like:
2702
2703 @example
2704 interface remote_bitbang
2705 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2706 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2707 @end example
2708
2709 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2710 named mysocket:
2711
2712 @example
2713 interface remote_bitbang
2714 remote_bitbang_port 0
2715 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2716 @end example
2717 @end deffn
2718
2719 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2720 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2721 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2722 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2723
2724 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2725 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2726 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2727 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2728 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2729 @end deffn
2730
2731 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2732 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2733 default values are used.
2734 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2735 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2736 @example
2737 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2738 @end example
2739 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2740 @example
2741 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2742 @end example
2743 @end deffn
2744
2745 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2746 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2747 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2748 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2749 target board.
2750
2751 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2752 @example
2753 usb_blaster_pin pin6 s
2754 reset_config srst_only
2755 @end example
2756 @end deffn
2757
2758 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2759 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2760 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2761 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2762 @end deffn
2763
2764 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_firmware} @var{path}
2765 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2766 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2767 @end deffn
2768
2769 @end deffn
2770
2771 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2772 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2773 This has one driver-specific command:
2774
2775 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2776 Display either the address of the I/O port
2777 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2778 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2779 This is a write-once setting.
2780 @end deffn
2781 @end deffn
2782
2783 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2784 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2785 transports.
2786
2787 @quotation Compatibility Note
2788 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2789 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2790 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2791 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2792 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2793 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2794 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2795 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2796 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2797 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2798 @end quotation
2799
2800 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2801 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2802 states.
2803 @end deffn
2804 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2805 Display free device internal memory.
2806 @end deffn
2807 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2808 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2809 command version.
2810 @end deffn
2811 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2812 Display the device configuration.
2813 @end deffn
2814 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2815 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2816 power state.
2817 @end deffn
2818 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2819 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2820 @end deffn
2821 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2822 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2823 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2824 IP configuration.
2825 @end deffn
2826 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2827 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2828 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2829 @end deffn
2830 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2831 Reset the current configuration.
2832 @end deffn
2833 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2834 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2835 @end deffn
2836 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write <channel> <data>}
2837 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2838 pairs.
2839
2840 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2841 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2842 @example
2843 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2844 @end example
2845 @end deffn
2846 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read <channel> <length>}
2847 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2848 pairs.
2849
2850 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2851 @example
2852 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2853 77a90000
2854 @end example
2855 @end deffn
2856 @deffn {Config} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2857 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2858 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2859 selection via USB address is deprecated and the serial number should be used
2860 instead.
2861
2862 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2863 @end deffn
2864 @deffn {Config} {jlink serial} <serial number>
2865 Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
2866 connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2867
2868 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2869 @end deffn
2870 @end deffn
2871
2872 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2873 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2874 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2875 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2876 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2877 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2878 configuration script.
2879
2880 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2881 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2882 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2883 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2884 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2885
2886 Known limitations:
2887 @itemize @bullet
2888 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2889 and 2.7 MHz.
2890 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2891 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2892 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2893 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2894 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2895 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2896 communications with the target.
2897 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2898 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2899 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2900 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2901 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2902 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2903 @end itemize
2904
2905 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2906 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2907 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2908 @end deffn
2909
2910 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_serial} serial
2911 Select a KitProg device by its @var{serial}. If left unspecified, the first
2912 device detected by OpenOCD will be used.
2913 @end deffn
2914
2915 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2916 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2917 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2918 target as a side-effect.
2919 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2920 @end deffn
2921
2922 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2923 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2924 version, and target voltage.
2925 @end deffn
2926 @end deffn
2927
2928 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2929 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2930 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2931 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2932 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2933
2934 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2935 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2936 This is a write-once setting.
2937 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2938
2939 @itemize @minus
2940 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2941 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2942 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2943 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2944 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2945 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2946 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2947 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2948 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2949 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2950 some versions of
2951 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2952 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2953 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2954 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2955 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2956 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2957 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2958 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2959 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2960 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2961 @end itemize
2962 @end deffn
2963
2964 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2965 Display either the address of the I/O port
2966 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2967 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2968 This is a write-once setting.
2969
2970 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2971 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
2972 you may encounter a problem.
2973 @end deffn
2974
2975 @deffn Command {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2976 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2977 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2978 @command{adapter_khz} configuration.
2979 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
2980 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
2981
2982 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
2983 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
2984 @quotation Tip
2985 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
2986 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
2987 @example
2988 > parport_toggling_time 1000
2989 > adapter_khz 500
2990 @end example
2991 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
2992 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
2993 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
2994 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
2995 large set of samples.
2996 Update the setting to match your measurement:
2997 @example
2998 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
2999 @end example
3000 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter_khz rate}
3001 commands given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
3002
3003 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
3004 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
3005 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
3006 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
3007 match for the adapter_khz rate you specified; be conservative.
3008 @end quotation
3009 @end deffn
3010
3011 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
3012 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
3013 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
3014 @end deffn
3015
3016 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3017 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3018
3019 @example
3020 interface parport
3021 parport_port 0x278
3022 parport_cable wiggler
3023 @end example
3024 @end deffn
3025
3026 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3027 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3028 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
3029 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
3030 @end deffn
3031 @end deffn
3032
3033 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3034 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3035 @end deffn
3036
3037 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3038 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3039 @end deffn
3040
3041 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3042 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3043
3044 @quotation Note
3045 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3046 which are not currently documented here.
3047 @end quotation
3048 @end deffn
3049
3050 @anchor{hla_interface}
3051 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3052 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3053 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3054 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3055
3056 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK and TI ICDI.
3057 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3058 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3059 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3060 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3061
3062 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3063 Currently Not Supported.
3064 @end deffn
3065
3066 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
3067 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3068 @end deffn
3069
3070 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi})
3071 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3072 @end deffn
3073
3074 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3075 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3076 @end deffn
3077
3078 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3079 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3080 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3081 @end deffn
3082 @end deffn
3083
3084 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3085 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3086 @end deffn
3087
3088 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3089 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3090 @end deffn
3091
3092 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ZY1000}
3093 This is the Zylin ZY1000 JTAG debugger.
3094 @end deffn
3095
3096 @quotation Note
3097 This defines some driver-specific commands,
3098 which are not currently documented here.
3099 @end quotation
3100
3101 @deffn Command power [@option{on}|@option{off}]
3102 Turn power switch to target on/off.
3103 No arguments: print status.
3104 @end deffn
3105
3106 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3107 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3108 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3109
3110 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3111 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3112 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3113 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3114 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3115 configuration on exit.
3116
3117 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3118 pinout.
3119
3120 @end deffn
3121
3122 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3123 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3124 of the one which is most popular.
3125
3126 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3127
3128 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3129 pinout.
3130
3131 @end deffn
3132
3133
3134 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3135 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3136 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3137
3138 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_variant} variant
3139 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3140 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3141
3142 @itemize @minus
3143 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3144 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3145 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3146 @end itemize
3147 @end deffn
3148
3149 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_device_desc} string
3150 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3151 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3152 @end deffn
3153 @end deffn
3154
3155 @section Transport Configuration
3156 @cindex Transport
3157 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3158 and the debug adapter you are using,
3159 several transports may be available to
3160 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3161 @deffn Command {transport list}
3162 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3163 version of OpenOCD.
3164 @end deffn
3165
3166 @deffn Command {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3167 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3168
3169 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3170 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3171 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3172 adapter's driver).
3173
3174 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3175 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3176 supported by the debug adapter.
3177
3178 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3179 transport, if any.
3180 @end deffn
3181
3182 @subsection JTAG Transport
3183 @cindex JTAG
3184 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3185 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3186 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3187 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3188 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3189 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3190
3191 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3192 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3193 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
3194 hla_jtag}.
3195
3196 @subsection SWD Transport
3197 @cindex SWD
3198 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3199 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3200 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3201 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3202 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3203 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3204 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3205
3206 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3207 swd}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3208 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
3209 hla_swd}.
3210
3211 @deffn Command {swd newdap} ...
3212 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3213 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3214 expected to change.
3215 @end deffn
3216 @deffn Command {swd wcr trn prescale}
3217 Updates TRN (turnaround delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3218 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3219 No parameters: displays current settings.
3220 @end deffn
3221
3222 @subsection SPI Transport
3223 @cindex SPI
3224 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3225 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3226 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3227 solution for flash programming.
3228
3229 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3230 @section JTAG Speed
3231 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3232 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3233 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3234 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3235 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3236 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3237 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3238 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3239 power management software that may be active.
3240
3241 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3242 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3243 target event handler.
3244 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3245 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3246 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3247 sets up those clocks).
3248 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3249 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3250 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3251 in the target config file.
3252 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3253 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3254 config file instead.
3255 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3256 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3257 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3258
3259 @example
3260 jtag_rclk 3000
3261 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3262 @end example
3263
3264 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3265 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3266 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3267 may not be the fastest solution.
3268
3269 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3270 instead of @command{adapter_khz}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3271 which support adaptive clocking.
3272
3273 @deffn {Command} adapter_khz max_speed_kHz
3274 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3275 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3276 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3277 than the speed specified.
3278
3279 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3280 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3281 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3282 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3283
3284 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3285 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3286 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3287 JTAG clocking after setup.
3288 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3289 If the interface device can not
3290 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3291 @end deffn
3292
3293 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3294 @cindex adaptive clocking
3295 @cindex RTCK
3296 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3297 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3298 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3299 @example
3300 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3301 jtag_rclk 3000
3302 @end example
3303 @end defun
3304
3305 @node Reset Configuration
3306 @chapter Reset Configuration
3307 @cindex Reset Configuration
3308
3309 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3310 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3311 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3312 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3313 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3314 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3315 Please see the various board files for examples.
3316
3317 @quotation Note
3318 To maintainers and integrators:
3319 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3320 Normally the board configuration file
3321 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3322 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3323
3324 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3325 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3326 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3327 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3328 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3329 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3330 @end quotation
3331
3332 @section Types of Reset
3333
3334 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3335 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3336 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3337
3338 @itemize @bullet
3339 @item
3340 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3341 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3342 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3343 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3344 @item
3345 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3346 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3347 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3348 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3349 @item
3350 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3351 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3352 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3353 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3354 @item
3355 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3356 several other types of reset.
3357 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3358 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3359 There may be individual module resets.
3360 @end itemize
3361
3362 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3363 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3364 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3365 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3366 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3367 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3368 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3369 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3370 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3371
3372 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3373 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3374
3375 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3376 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3377 common issues are:
3378
3379 @itemize @bullet
3380
3381 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3382 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3383 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3384 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3385 when either of those signals is not connected.
3386 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3387 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3388 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3389 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3390
3391 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3392 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3393 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3394 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3395
3396 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3397 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3398 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3399 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3400 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3401 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3402 hardware debouncing.
3403 Use the @command{adapter_nsrst_delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3404 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3405
3406 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3407 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3408 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3409 to use push/pull output drivers.
3410 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3411 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3412 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3413 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3414
3415 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3416 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3417 issues (not limited to errata).
3418 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3419 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3420 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3421 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3422 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3423 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3424 @end itemize
3425
3426 There can also be other issues.
3427 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3428 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3429 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3430 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3431 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3432 Agreement (NDA).
3433
3434 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3435 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3436 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3437
3438 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3439 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3440
3441 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3442
3443 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_assert_width milliseconds
3444 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3445 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3446 allowing it to be deasserted.
3447 @end deffn
3448
3449 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_delay milliseconds
3450 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3451 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3452 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3453 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3454 @end deffn
3455
3456 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_assert_width milliseconds
3457 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3458 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3459 allowing it to be deasserted.
3460 @end deffn
3461
3462 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_delay milliseconds
3463 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3464 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3465 @end deffn
3466
3467 @anchor {reset_config}
3468 @deffn {Command} reset_config mode_flag ...
3469 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3470 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3471 configuration scripts.
3472
3473 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3474 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3475 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3476 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3477 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3478 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3479 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3480 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3481
3482 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3483 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3484 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3485 -- may be specified at a time.
3486 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3487 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3488 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3489 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3490 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3491
3492 @itemize
3493 @item
3494 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3495 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3496 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3497 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3498 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3499
3500 @quotation Tip
3501 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3502 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3503 @end quotation
3504
3505 @item
3506 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3507 signal implementations.
3508 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3509 indicating everything behaves normally.
3510 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3511 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3512 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3513 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3514 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3515 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3516 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3517
3518 @item
3519 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3520 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
3521 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3522 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3523 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3524 while SRST is asserted.
3525 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3526 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3527
3528 @item
3529 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3530 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3531 is required to use this option.
3532 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3533 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3534 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3535 be asserted before any target connection.
3536 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3537 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3538 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3539 @end itemize
3540
3541 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3542 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3543 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3544 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3545 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3546
3547 @itemize
3548 @item
3549 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3550 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3551 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3552 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3553
3554 @item
3555 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3556 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3557 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3558 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3559 power-up and pressing a reset button.
3560 @end itemize
3561 @end deffn
3562
3563 @section Custom Reset Handling
3564 @cindex events
3565
3566 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3567 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3568 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3569 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3570 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3571 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3572
3573 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3574 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3575 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3576 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3577 want to reset everything at once.
3578
3579 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3580 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3581 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3582 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3583 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3584 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3585 needs special attention.
3586
3587 Experiment with lower level operations, such as @command{jtag_reset}
3588 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3589 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3590 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3591 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3592 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3593 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3594 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3595
3596 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3597 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3598 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3599 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3600 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3601
3602 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} init_reset mode
3603 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3604 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3605 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3606 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3607 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3608 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3609 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3610 or potentially some other value.
3611
3612 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3613 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3614 operations such as @command{jtag_reset}.
3615 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3616 (or their associated targets)
3617 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3618
3619 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3620 they return.
3621 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3622 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3623 @end deffn
3624
3625 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init}
3626 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3627 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3628 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3629 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3630 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3631 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3632 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3633 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3634 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3635 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3636 @end deffn
3637
3638 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init-reset}
3639 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3640 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3641 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3642 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3643 @end deffn
3644
3645
3646 @node TAP Declaration
3647 @chapter TAP Declaration
3648 @cindex TAP declaration
3649 @cindex TAP configuration
3650
3651 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3652 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3653
3654 @itemize @bullet
3655 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3656 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3657 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3658 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3659 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3660 start running that code.
3661 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3662 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3663 and missing connections.
3664 @end itemize
3665
3666 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3667 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3668 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3669 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3670 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3671
3672 @section Scan Chains
3673 @cindex scan chain
3674
3675 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3676 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3677 They also need to be added to
3678 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3679 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3680 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3681 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3682 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3683 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3684 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3685 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3686
3687 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3688 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3689 command, presented in the next chapter.
3690 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3691 debugging targets.)
3692 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3693
3694 @verbatim
3695 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3696 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3697 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3698 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3699 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3700 @end verbatim
3701
3702 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3703 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3704 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3705 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3706 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3707 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3708 until they are told to do so.
3709
3710 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3711 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3712 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3713 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3714
3715 @example
3716 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3717 @end example
3718
3719 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3720 by a given chip.
3721 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3722 and so forth.
3723 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3724 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3725 both inside a single chip and between them.
3726 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3727
3728 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
3729 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3730 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3731 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3732 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3733 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3734 includes commands something like this:
3735
3736 @example
3737 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3738 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3739 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3740 @end example
3741
3742 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3743 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3744 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3745
3746 @deffn Command {jtag names}
3747 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3748 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3749 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3750 @example
3751 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3752 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3753 @}
3754 @end example
3755 @end deffn
3756
3757 @deffn Command {scan_chain}
3758 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3759 and their status.
3760 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3761 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3762 but systems with a JTAG router can
3763 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3764 @end deffn
3765
3766 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3767 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3768
3769 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3770 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3771
3772 @section TAP Names
3773 @cindex dotted name
3774
3775 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3776 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3777 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3778 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3779 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3780 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3781 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3782 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3783
3784 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3785 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3786 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3787
3788 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3789
3790 @c shouldn't this be(come) a {Config Command}?
3791 @deffn Command {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3792 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3793 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3794
3795 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3796 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3797 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3798 overridable.
3799
3800 @cindex TAP naming convention
3801 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3802 and should follow this convention:
3803
3804 @itemize @bullet
3805 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
3806 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
3807 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
3808 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
3809 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
3810 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
3811 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
3812 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
3813 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
3814 with a single TAP;
3815 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
3816 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
3817 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
3818 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
3819 @end itemize
3820
3821 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
3822
3823 @itemize @bullet
3824 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
3825 @*The length in bits of the
3826 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
3827 @end itemize
3828
3829 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
3830
3831 @itemize @bullet
3832 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
3833 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
3834 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
3835 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
3836 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
3837 (the TAP is linked in).
3838 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
3839 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
3840 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
3841 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
3842 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
3843 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
3844 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
3845 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
3846 values that were found but not included in the list.
3847
3848 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
3849 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
3850 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
3851 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
3852 hardware to find these values.
3853 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3854 @item @code{-ignore-version}
3855 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
3856 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
3857 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
3858 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
3859 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
3860 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
3861 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
3862 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
3863 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
3864 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
3865 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
3866 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
3867 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
3868 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
3869 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
3870 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
3871 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
3872 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
3873 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
3874 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
3875 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
3876 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
3877 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
3878 @end itemize
3879 @end deffn
3880
3881 @section Other TAP commands
3882
3883 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
3884 @deffnx Command {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
3885 At this writing this TAP attribute
3886 mechanism is used only for event handling.
3887 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
3888 mechanism for debugger targets.)
3889 See the next section for information about the available events.
3890
3891 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
3892 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
3893 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
3894 @end deffn
3895
3896 @section TAP Events
3897 @cindex events
3898 @cindex TAP events
3899
3900 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
3901 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
3902 The other applies to debugger targets,
3903 which are associated with certain TAPs.
3904
3905 The TAP events currently defined are:
3906
3907 @itemize @bullet
3908 @item @b{post-reset}
3909 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
3910 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
3911 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
3912 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
3913 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
3914
3915 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
3916 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
3917 of any particular target.
3918 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
3919 @item @b{setup}
3920 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
3921 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
3922 @item @b{tap-disable}
3923 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
3924 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
3925 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3926 @item @b{tap-enable}
3927 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
3928 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
3929 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3930 @end itemize
3931
3932 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
3933 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
3934 contents to be accurate), you might:
3935
3936 @example
3937 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
3938 echo "JTAG Reset done"
3939 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
3940 @}
3941 @end example
3942
3943
3944 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
3945 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
3946 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
3947 @cindex jrc
3948
3949 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
3950 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
3951 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
3952 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
3953 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
3954
3955 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
3956 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
3957 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
3958 be visible.
3959 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
3960 ignores, such as:
3961
3962 @itemize
3963 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
3964 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
3965 TAPs receive new instructions.
3966 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
3967 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
3968 @end itemize
3969
3970 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
3971 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
3972 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
3973 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
3974
3975 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
3976 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
3977
3978 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
3979 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
3980 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
3981 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
3982 should define TAP event handlers using
3983 code that looks something like this:
3984
3985 @example
3986 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
3987 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3988 @}
3989 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
3990 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3991 @}
3992 @end example
3993
3994 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
3995
3996 @example
3997 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
3998 @end example
3999
4000 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
4001 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
4002 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
4003 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
4004
4005 @deffn Command {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4006 If necessary, disables the tap
4007 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4008 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4009 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4010 and "0" if it is disabled.
4011 @end deffn
4012
4013 @deffn Command {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4014 If necessary, enables the tap
4015 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4016 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4017 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4018 and "0" if it is disabled.
4019 @end deffn
4020
4021 @deffn Command {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4022 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4023 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4024 and "0" if it is disabled.
4025
4026 @quotation Note
4027 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4028 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4029 @end quotation
4030 @end deffn
4031
4032 @anchor{autoprobing}
4033 @section Autoprobing
4034 @cindex autoprobe
4035 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4036
4037 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4038 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4039 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4040 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4041
4042 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4043 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4044 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4045 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4046 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4047 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4048 right when they come out of reset).
4049
4050 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4051
4052 @example
4053 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4054 reset_config trst_and_srst
4055 jtag_rclk 8
4056 @end example
4057
4058 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4059 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4060
4061 @enumerate
4062 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4063 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4064 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4065 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4066 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4067 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4068 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4069 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4070 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4071 that is discovered.
4072 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4073 register, it will report it.
4074 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4075 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4076 @end enumerate
4077
4078 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4079 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4080 that's a bit more complex:
4081
4082 @example
4083 clock speed 8 kHz
4084 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4085 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4086 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4087 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4088 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4089 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4090 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4091 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4092 @end example
4093
4094 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4095 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4096 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4097 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4098 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4099 and so forth.
4100
4101 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4102 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4103 @cindex DAP declaration
4104
4105 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4106 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4107 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4108 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4109 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4110
4111 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4112
4113 @deffn Command {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4114 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4115 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4116 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4117 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4118
4119 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4120
4121 @itemize @bullet
4122 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4123 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4124 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4125 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4126 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4127 @end itemize
4128 @end deffn
4129
4130 @deffn Command {dap names}
4131 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4132 for TCL scripting.
4133 @end deffn
4134
4135 @deffn Command {dap info} [num]
4136 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4137 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4138 @end deffn
4139
4140 @deffn Command {dap init}
4141 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4142 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4143 initialization, too.
4144 @end deffn
4145
4146 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4147
4148 @deffn Command {$dap_name info} [num]
4149 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4150 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4151 @end deffn
4152
4153 @deffn Command {$dap_name apid} [num]
4154 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4155 @end deffn
4156
4157 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4158 @deffn Command {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4159 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4160 or set a new value @var{value}.
4161 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4162 @end deffn
4163
4164 @deffn Command {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4165 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4166 @end deffn
4167
4168 @deffn Command {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4169 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4170 value @var{value}.
4171
4172 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4173 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4174 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4175
4176 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4177 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4178 @end deffn
4179
4180 @deffn Command {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4181 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4182 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4183 @end deffn
4184
4185 @deffn Command {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4186 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4187 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4188 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4189 @end deffn
4190
4191 @deffn Command {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4192 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4193
4194 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4195 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4196 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4197 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4198 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4199 for details.
4200
4201 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4202 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4203 the pattern:
4204 @example
4205 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4206 @end example
4207
4208 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4209 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4210 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4211 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4212 @example
4213 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr 1 << 27]
4214 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4215 @end example
4216
4217 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4218 @example
4219 set CSW_SPROT [expr 1 << 30]
4220 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4221 @end example
4222
4223 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4224 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4225
4226 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4227 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4228 example with a proper dap name:
4229 @example
4230 xxx.dap apcsw default
4231 @end example
4232 @end deffn
4233
4234 @deffn Command {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4235 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4236 Disabled by default
4237 @end deffn
4238
4239
4240 @node CPU Configuration
4241 @chapter CPU Configuration
4242 @cindex GDB target
4243
4244 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4245 You can also access these targets without GDB
4246 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4247 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4248 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4249 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4250
4251 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4252 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4253
4254 @section Target List
4255 @cindex target, current
4256 @cindex target, list
4257
4258 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4259 where each member has a name.
4260 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4261 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4262 (plural!) command.
4263 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4264 look like with more than one:
4265 @verbatim
4266 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4267 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4268 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4269 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4270 @end verbatim
4271
4272 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4273 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4274 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4275 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4276 space seen by that current target.
4277 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4278 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4279 are examples; and there are many more.
4280
4281 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4282
4283 @deffn Command {target current}
4284 Returns the name of the current target.
4285 @end deffn
4286
4287 @deffn Command {target names}
4288 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4289 @example
4290 foreach t [target names] @{
4291 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4292 @}
4293 @end example
4294 @end deffn
4295
4296 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4297 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4298
4299 @deffn Command targets [name]
4300 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4301 command names are singular.}
4302
4303 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4304 targets in a user friendly form.
4305
4306 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4307 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4308 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4309 @end deffn
4310
4311 @section Target CPU Types
4312 @cindex target type
4313 @cindex CPU type
4314
4315 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4316 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4317 when calling @command{target create}.
4318 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4319 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4320 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4321 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4322 what core-specific commands may be available
4323 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4324 and more.
4325
4326 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4327 since there's a command to list them.
4328
4329 @anchor{targettypes}
4330 @deffn Command {target types}
4331 Lists all supported target types.
4332 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4333
4334 @itemize @bullet
4335 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores
4336 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4337 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4338 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4339 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU
4340 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core
4341 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4342 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4343 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4344 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7 core with an MMU
4345 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7 core, supporting only the
4346 compact Thumb2 instruction set.
4347 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU
4348 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e
4349 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4350 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4351 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4352 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4353 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb)
4354 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926
4355 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core
4356 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4357 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4358 @item @code{openrisc} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4359 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4360 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4361 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4362 @itemize @minus
4363 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,jtag})
4364 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4365 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4366 @end itemize
4367 And two debug interfaces cores:
4368 @itemize @minus
4369 @item @code{Advanced debug interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,adv_debug_sys})
4370 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,dbg_interface})
4371 @end itemize
4372 @end itemize
4373 @end deffn
4374
4375 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4376 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4377 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4378 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4379 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4380 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4381 reflect design generations;
4382 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4383 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4384
4385 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4386 @section Target Configuration
4387
4388 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4389 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4390 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4391 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4392 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4393
4394 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4395 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4396 optional parts.
4397 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4398 command, created as part of target creation.
4399
4400 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4401 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4402 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4403 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4404 to be much more board-specific.
4405 The key steps you use might look something like this
4406
4407 @example
4408 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4409 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4410 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4411 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4412 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4413 @end example
4414
4415 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4416 on-chip SRAM.
4417 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4418 writes to target memory;
4419 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4420 GDB memory checksumming;
4421 and more.
4422
4423 @quotation Warning
4424 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4425 inaccessible when application code
4426 (such as an operating system)
4427 enables or disables the MMU.
4428 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
4429 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4430 easy access to other addresses needed.
4431 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4432 @end quotation
4433
4434 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4435 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4436 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4437 controllers.
4438 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4439 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4440 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4441
4442 @deffn Command {target create} target_name type configparams...
4443 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4444 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4445 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4446 purposes including additional configuration.
4447
4448 @itemize @bullet
4449 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4450 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4451 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4452 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4453
4454 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4455 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4456 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4457 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4458 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4459 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4460 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4461
4462 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4463 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4464 @end itemize
4465 @end deffn
4466
4467 @deffn Command {$target_name configure} configparams...
4468 The options accepted by this command may also be
4469 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4470 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4471 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4472
4473 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4474 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4475 and changing its endianness.
4476
4477 @itemize @bullet
4478
4479 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4480 used to access this target.
4481
4482 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4483 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4484 create and manage DAP instances.
4485
4486 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4487 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4488
4489 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4490 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4491 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4492 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4493 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4494 same event name assigns only one handler.
4495
4496 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4497 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4498
4499 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4500 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4501 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4502 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4503 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4504 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4505 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4506
4507 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4508 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4509 or virtual address is being used.
4510
4511 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4512 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4513
4514 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4515 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4516 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4517 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4518 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4519
4520 @anchor{rtostype}
4521 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4522 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
4523 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
4524 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx}
4525 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4526
4527 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4528 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4529 access the target for debugging.
4530
4531 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4532 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4533 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4534 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4535
4536 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
4537 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
4538 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
4539 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
4540 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
4541
4542 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
4543 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
4544 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
4545 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
4546 command @command{gdb_port}.
4547 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
4548 @end itemize
4549 @end deffn
4550
4551 @section Other $target_name Commands
4552 @cindex object command
4553
4554 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4555 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4556
4557 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4558 Once a button is created a button
4559 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4560 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4561 configure it like this:
4562
4563 @example
4564 # Create
4565 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4566 # Modify
4567 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4568 # Query
4569 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4570 # Report
4571 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4572 @end example
4573
4574 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4575 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4576
4577 @example
4578 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4579 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4580 @end example
4581
4582 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4583
4584 @deffn Command {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4585 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_halt}
4586 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_poll}
4587 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_reset}
4588 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4589 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4590 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4591 They are not otherwise documented here.
4592 @end deffn
4593
4594 @deffn Command {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4595 @deffnx Command {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4596 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4597 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
4598 while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4599 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4600 the target side uses raw memory.
4601
4602 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4603 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4604 The script orientation comes from working with data
4605 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4606 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4607 and neither store nor return those values.
4608
4609 @itemize
4610 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4611 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
4612 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4613 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4614 @end itemize
4615 @end deffn
4616
4617 @deffn Command {$target_name cget} queryparm
4618 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4619 @command{$target_name configure}
4620 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4621 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4622 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4623 There are a few special cases:
4624
4625 @itemize @bullet
4626 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4627 event named @var{event_name}.
4628 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4629 two parameters.
4630 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4631 This is a special case because this is set using
4632 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4633 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4634 @end itemize
4635
4636 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4637 all the targets you might use something like this:
4638
4639 @example
4640 foreach name [target names] @{
4641 set y [$name cget -endian]
4642 set z [$name cget -type]
4643 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4644 $x $name $y $z]
4645 @}
4646 @end example
4647 @end deffn
4648
4649 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4650 @deffn Command {$target_name curstate}
4651 Displays the current target state:
4652 @code{debug-running},
4653 @code{halted},
4654 @code{reset},
4655 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4656 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4657 @end deffn
4658
4659 @deffn Command {$target_name eventlist}
4660 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4661 currently associated with this target.
4662 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4663 @end deffn
4664
4665 @deffn Command {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4666 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4667 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4668 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4669 @end deffn
4670
4671 @deffn Command {$target_name mdw} addr [count]
4672 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdh} addr [count]
4673 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdb} addr [count]
4674 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4675 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4676 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4677 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4678 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4679 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4680 @end deffn
4681
4682 @deffn Command {$target_name mww} addr word
4683 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwh} addr halfword
4684 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwb} addr byte
4685 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4686 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4687 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4688 @end deffn
4689
4690 @anchor{targetevents}
4691 @section Target Events
4692 @cindex target events
4693 @cindex events
4694 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4695 For example:
4696 @itemize @bullet
4697 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4698 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4699 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4700 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4701 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4702 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4703 to set up system clocks or
4704 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4705 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4706 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4707 @end itemize
4708
4709 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4710 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4711 @command{target create ... -event}.
4712
4713 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4714 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4715 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4716
4717 @example
4718 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
4719 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4720 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4721 @}
4722 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
4723 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
4724 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4725 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4726 @}
4727 @end example
4728
4729 The following target events are defined:
4730
4731 @itemize @bullet
4732 @item @b{debug-halted}
4733 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4734 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4735 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
4736 @item @b{early-halted}
4737 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4738 @item @b{examine-start}
4739 @* Before target examine is called.
4740 @item @b{examine-end}
4741 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4742 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4743 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
4744 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
4745 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
4746 connect GDB to running target.
4747 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
4748 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
4749 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
4750 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
4751 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
4752 is in RAM or read only memory.
4753 Default is @code{halt}
4754 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4755 @* When GDB disconnects
4756 @item @b{gdb-end}
4757 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4758 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
4759 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
4760 @code{reset init})
4761 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
4762 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
4763 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
4764 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
4765 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
4766 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
4767 @item @b{gdb-start}
4768 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
4769 @item @b{halted}
4770 @* The target has halted
4771 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
4772 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4773 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
4774 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
4775 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
4776 @item @b{reset-assert}
4777 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4778 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
4779 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
4780 it instead of asserting SRST.
4781 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
4782 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
4783 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
4784 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
4785 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4786 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
4787 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
4788 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
4789 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4790 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
4791 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
4792 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4793 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
4794 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
4795 released on the scan chain.
4796 @item @b{reset-end}
4797 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
4798 @item @b{reset-init}
4799 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
4800 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
4801
4802 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
4803 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
4804 multiplexing, and so on.
4805 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
4806 the target clocks are fully set up.)
4807 @item @b{reset-start}
4808 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
4809 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
4810
4811 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
4812 or @command{adapter_khz} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
4813 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
4814 @item @b{resume-start}
4815 @* Before any target is resumed
4816 @item @b{resume-end}
4817 @* After all targets have resumed
4818 @item @b{resumed}
4819 @* Target has resumed
4820 @item @b{trace-config}
4821 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
4822 @end itemize
4823
4824 @node Flash Commands
4825 @chapter Flash Commands
4826
4827 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
4828 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
4829 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
4830 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
4831 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
4832 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
4833 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
4834 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
4835 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
4836
4837 Flash Steps:
4838 @enumerate
4839 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
4840 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
4841 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
4842 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
4843 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
4844 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
4845 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
4846 @item GDB Flashing
4847 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
4848 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
4849 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
4850 @end enumerate
4851
4852 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
4853 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
4854 so that it can't boot.
4855 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
4856 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
4857
4858 @anchor{norconfiguration}
4859 @section Flash Configuration Commands
4860 @cindex flash configuration
4861
4862 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
4863 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
4864 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
4865 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
4866 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
4867 see the driver-specific documentation.
4868
4869 @itemize @bullet
4870 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
4871 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
4872 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
4873 associated with the flash bank being declared.
4874 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
4875 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
4876 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
4877 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
4878 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
4879 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
4880 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
4881 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4882 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
4883 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4884 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
4885 commands to the flash controller.
4886 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
4887 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
4888 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
4889 for more information.
4890 @end itemize
4891 @quotation Note
4892 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
4893 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
4894 @end quotation
4895 @end deffn
4896
4897 @comment the REAL name for this command is "ocd_flash_banks"
4898 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
4899 @deffn Command {flash banks}
4900 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
4901 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4902 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
4903 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
4904 @end deffn
4905
4906 @deffn Command {flash list}
4907 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
4908 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4909 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
4910 @end deffn
4911
4912 @deffn Command {flash probe} num
4913 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
4914 depends on the flash type.
4915 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4916 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
4917 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
4918 but most don't bother.
4919 @end deffn
4920
4921 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
4922 @cindex flash erasing
4923 @cindex flash reading
4924 @cindex flash writing
4925 @cindex flash programming
4926 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
4927
4928 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
4929 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
4930 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
4931 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
4932 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
4933
4934 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
4935 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
4936 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
4937 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
4938 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
4939
4940 @quotation Note
4941 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
4942 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
4943 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
4944 back to a flash bank.
4945 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
4946 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
4947 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
4948 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
4949 Avoid confusing the two command models.
4950 @end quotation
4951
4952 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
4953 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
4954 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
4955 disabled first.
4956 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
4957 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
4958 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
4959
4960 @deffn Command {flash erase_sector} num first last
4961 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
4962 up to and including @var{last}.
4963 Sector numbering starts at 0.
4964 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
4965 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4966 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4967 @end deffn
4968
4969 @deffn Command {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
4970 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
4971 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
4972 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
4973 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
4974 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
4975 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
4976 the specified length must stay within that bank.
4977 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
4978 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
4979 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
4980 before erase starts.
4981 @end deffn
4982
4983 @deffn Command {flash fillw} address word length
4984 @deffnx Command {flash fillh} address halfword length
4985 @deffnx Command {flash fillb} address byte length
4986 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4987 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4988 starting at @var{address} and continuing
4989 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
4990 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
4991 before issuing this command.
4992 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
4993 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
4994 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
4995 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
4996 @end deffn
4997 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
4998
4999 @deffn Command {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
5000 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
5001 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
5002 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
5003 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5004 @end deffn
5005
5006 @deffn Command {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5007 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5008 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5009 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5010 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5011 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5012 @end deffn
5013
5014 @deffn Command {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5015 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5016 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5017 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5018 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5019 @end deffn
5020
5021 @deffn Command {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5022 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5023 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5024 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5025 to the base address for each section in the image.
5026 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5027 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5028 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5029 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5030 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5031 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5032 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5033 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5034 each image section.
5035
5036 @quotation Warning
5037 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5038 data you want to preserve.
5039 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5040 sections might be erased with no notice.
5041 @itemize
5042 @item
5043 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5044 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5045 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5046 @item
5047 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5048 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5049 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5050 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5051 @end itemize
5052 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5053 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5054 @end quotation
5055
5056 @end deffn
5057
5058 @section Other Flash commands
5059 @cindex flash protection
5060
5061 @deffn Command {flash erase_check} num
5062 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5063 and display that status.
5064 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5065 @end deffn
5066
5067 @deffn Command {flash info} num [sectors]
5068 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5069 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5070
5071 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5072 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5073 and possibly stale information.
5074 @end deffn
5075
5076 @anchor{flashprotect}
5077 @deffn Command {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5078 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5079 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5080 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5081 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5082 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5083 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5084 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5085 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5086 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5087 @end deffn
5088
5089 @deffn Command {flash padded_value} num value
5090 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5091 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5092 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5093 @end deffn
5094
5095 @anchor{program}
5096 @deffn Command {program} filename [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5097 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5098 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5099 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5100 @end deffn
5101
5102 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5103 @section Flash Driver List
5104 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5105 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5106 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5107
5108 @deffn {Flash Driver} virtual
5109 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5110 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5111
5112 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5113
5114 @itemize
5115 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5116 @end itemize
5117
5118 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5119 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5120 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5121 @example
5122 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5123 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5124 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5125 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5126 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5127 @end example
5128 @end deffn
5129
5130 @subsection External Flash
5131
5132 @deffn {Flash Driver} cfi
5133 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5134 @cindex CFI
5135 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5136 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5137 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5138 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5139 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5140 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5141 configure a bus and its timings), or
5142 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5143 on the flash chip.
5144 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5145 speed up operation.
5146
5147 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5148
5149 @itemize
5150 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5151 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5152 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5153 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5154 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5155 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5156 @end itemize
5157
5158 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5159 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5160
5161 @example
5162 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5163 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5164 @end example
5165
5166 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5167 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5168 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5169
5170 @example
5171 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5172 @end example
5173
5174 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5175 @end deffn
5176
5177 @deffn {Flash Driver} jtagspi
5178 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5179 @cindex SPI
5180 @cindex jtagspi
5181 @cindex bscan_spi
5182 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5183 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5184 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5185 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5186 accessed through JTAG.
5187
5188 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5189 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5190 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5191 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5192 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5193 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5194
5195 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5196 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5197 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5198 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5199 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5200 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5201 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5202 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5203
5204 @itemize
5205 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5206 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5207 @var{USER1} instruction.
5208 @end itemize
5209
5210 @example
5211 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5212 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5213 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5214 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5215 @end example
5216 @end deffn
5217
5218 @deffn {Flash Driver} xcf
5219 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5220 @cindex xcf
5221 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5222 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5223 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5224 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5225 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5226
5227 @deffn Command {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5228 command accepts additional parameters:
5229 @itemize
5230 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5231 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5232 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5233 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5234 in master mode.
5235 @end itemize
5236 @example
5237 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5238 @end example
5239 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5240 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5241 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5242 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5243 dedicated sector.
5244 @end deffn
5245
5246 @deffn Command {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5247 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5248 button.
5249 @example
5250 xcf configure 0
5251 @end example
5252 @end deffn
5253
5254 Additional driver notes:
5255 @itemize
5256 @item Only single revision supported.
5257 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5258 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5259 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5260 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5261 @end itemize
5262 @end deffn
5263
5264 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpcspifi
5265 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5266 @cindex SPIFI
5267 @cindex lpcspifi
5268 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5269 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5270 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5271
5272 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5273 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5274 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5275 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5276 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5277
5278 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5279 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5280 are configured by the driver.
5281
5282 @example
5283 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5284 @end example
5285
5286 @end deffn
5287
5288 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmsmi
5289 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5290 @cindex SMI
5291 @cindex stmsmi
5292 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5293 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5294 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5295 SPI flash devices.
5296 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5297 flash devices can be connected.
5298
5299 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5300 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5301 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5302 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5303 the flash content.
5304
5305 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5306 to identify the memory bank.
5307 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5308 flash size, are detected automatically.
5309
5310 @example
5311 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5312 @end example
5313
5314 @end deffn
5315
5316 @deffn {Flash Driver} mrvlqspi
5317 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
5318 Microcontroller platform.
5319
5320 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
5321 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
5322
5323 @example
5324 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
5325 @end example
5326
5327 @end deffn
5328
5329 @deffn {Flash Driver} ath79
5330 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
5331 @cindex ath79
5332 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
5333 chip selects.
5334 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
5335 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
5336 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
5337 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5338 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
5339 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
5340
5341 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5342 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
5343 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
5344 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
5345 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
5346 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
5347 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
5348 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
5349 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
5350 with the default CS0.
5351 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
5352 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
5353 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
5354
5355 @example
5356 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5357
5358 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different for each,
5359 # otherwise the write_image command is not able to distinguish the
5360 # banks.
5361 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
5362 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
5363 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
5364 @end example
5365
5366 @end deffn
5367
5368 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5369
5370 @deffn {Flash Driver} aduc702x
5371 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5372 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5373 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5374 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5375 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5376
5377 @example
5378 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5379 @end example
5380 @end deffn
5381
5382 @deffn {Flash Driver} ambiqmicro
5383 @cindex ambiqmicro
5384 @cindex apollo
5385 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
5386 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5387 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
5388 with the target using SWD.
5389
5390 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
5391 the device class of the MCU.
5392 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
5393 to set up the flash banks.
5394 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
5395 sizes of an Apollo chip.
5396
5397 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
5398 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
5399 and the second bank starts after the first.
5400
5401 @example
5402 # Flash bank 0
5403 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5404 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
5405 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
5406 $_TARGETNAME
5407 @end example
5408
5409 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5410 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5411 are available to the user.
5412
5413 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
5414
5415 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5416 Erase entire bank.
5417 @end deffn
5418 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5419 Erase device pages.
5420 @end deffn
5421 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5422 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5423 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
5424 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
5425 the flash.
5426 @end deffn
5427 @end deffn
5428
5429 @anchor{at91samd}
5430 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91samd
5431 @cindex at91samd
5432 All members of the ATSAMD, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5433 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5434 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5435
5436 @deffn Command {at91samd chip-erase}
5437 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5438 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5439 processor to be halted.
5440 @end deffn
5441
5442 @deffn Command {at91samd set-security}
5443 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5444 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5445 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5446 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
5447 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
5448
5449 @example
5450 at91samd set-security enable
5451 @end example
5452 @end deffn
5453
5454 @deffn Command {at91samd eeprom}
5455 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
5456 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
5457 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
5458 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
5459 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
5460 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
5461 in order to disable this feature.
5462
5463 @example
5464 at91samd eeprom
5465 at91samd eeprom 1024
5466 @end example
5467 @end deffn
5468
5469 @deffn Command {at91samd bootloader}
5470 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
5471 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5472 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
5473 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
5474 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5475
5476 @example
5477 at91samd bootloader
5478 at91samd bootloader 16384
5479 @end example
5480 @end deffn
5481
5482 @deffn Command {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
5483 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5484 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5485 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5486 @end deffn
5487
5488 @deffn Command {at91samd nvmuserrow}
5489 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
5490 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
5491 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
5492 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
5493 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
5494 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
5495 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
5496
5497 @example
5498 # Read user row
5499 >at91samd nvmuserrow
5500 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5501 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
5502 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5503 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low byte unchanged
5504 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
5505 @end example
5506 @end deffn
5507
5508 @end deffn
5509
5510 @anchor{at91sam3}
5511 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam3
5512 @cindex at91sam3
5513 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
5514 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
5515 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
5516 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
5517 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
5518 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
5519 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
5520 chips are confirmed.}
5521
5522 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
5523 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
5524 the following fixed locations:
5525
5526 @example
5527 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
5528 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5529 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
5530 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5531 @end example
5532
5533 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
5534 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
5535 to the @command{flash bank} command:
5536
5537 @itemize
5538 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
5539 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
5540 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
5541 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
5542 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
5543 @end itemize
5544
5545 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
5546
5547 @deffn Command {at91sam3 gpnvm}
5548 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
5549 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
5550 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
5551 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
5552 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
5553 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
5554
5555 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
5556 modifies that GPNVM bit.
5557 @end deffn
5558
5559 @deffn Command {at91sam3 info}
5560 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
5561 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
5562 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
5563 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
5564 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
5565 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
5566 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
5567 @end deffn
5568
5569 @deffn Command {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
5570 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
5571 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
5572 @end deffn
5573 @end deffn
5574
5575 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4
5576 @cindex at91sam4
5577 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
5578 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5579 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5580 @end deffn
5581
5582 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4l
5583 @cindex at91sam4l
5584 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
5585 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5586 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5587
5588 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
5589 @deffn Command {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
5590 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
5591 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5592 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5593 @end deffn
5594 @end deffn
5595
5596 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsamv
5597 @cindex atsamv
5598 All members of the ATSAMV, ATSAMS, and ATSAME families from
5599 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
5600 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5601 @end deffn
5602
5603 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam7
5604 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
5605 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
5606 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
5607 register, and autoconfigures itself.
5608
5609 @example
5610 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5611 @end example
5612
5613 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
5614 provide additional parameters in the following order:
5615
5616 @itemize
5617 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
5618 @item @var{banks}
5619 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
5620 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
5621 @item @var{pages_size}
5622 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
5623 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
5624 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
5625 @end itemize
5626
5627 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
5628 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
5629 will be autoconfigured.
5630 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
5631
5632 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
5633 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
5634 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
5635 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
5636 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
5637
5638 @deffn Command {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
5639 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
5640 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
5641 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
5642 are not truly general purpose).
5643 @quotation Note
5644 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
5645 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
5646 @end quotation
5647 @end deffn
5648 @end deffn
5649
5650 @deffn {Flash Driver} avr
5651 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
5652 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
5653 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5654 @end deffn
5655
5656 @deffn {Flash Driver} bluenrg-x
5657 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1 and BlueNRG-2 Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0 core and internal flash memory.
5658 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
5659 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
5660
5661 @example
5662 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5663 @end example
5664
5665 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
5666 each single sector one by one.
5667
5668 @example
5669 flash erase_sector 0 0 79 # It will perform a mass erase on BlueNRG-1
5670 @end example
5671
5672 @example
5673 flash erase_sector 0 0 127 # It will perform a mass erase on BlueNRG-2
5674 @end example
5675
5676 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
5677 @end deffn
5678
5679 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc26xx
5680 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
5681 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
5682 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
5683 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
5684 starts at address 0.
5685
5686 @example
5687 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5688 @end example
5689 @end deffn
5690
5691 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc3220sf
5692 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
5693 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
5694 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
5695 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
5696 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
5697 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
5698 and programming the serial flash.
5699
5700 @example
5701 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5702 @end example
5703 @end deffn
5704
5705 @deffn {Flash Driver} efm32
5706 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
5707 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
5708 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
5709 autoconfigures itself.
5710 @example
5711 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5712 @end example
5713 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
5714 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
5715 this via the following command:
5716 @example
5717 efm32 debuglock num
5718 @end example
5719 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5720 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
5721 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
5722 supported.}
5723 @end deffn
5724
5725 @deffn {Flash Driver} esirisc
5726 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
5727 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
5728 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
5729 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
5730 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
5731
5732 @example
5733 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
5734 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
5735 @end example
5736
5737 @deffn Command {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
5738 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
5739 @end deffn
5740
5741 @deffn Command {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
5742 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
5743 is an uncommon operation.}
5744 @end deffn
5745 @end deffn
5746
5747 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm3
5748 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
5749 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
5750 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
5751 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5752 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
5753 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
5754
5755 @example
5756 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5757 @end example
5758 @end deffn
5759
5760 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm4
5761 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
5762 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
5763 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
5764 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5765 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
5766 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
5767 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
5768 characters) ignored.
5769
5770 @example
5771 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
5772 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
5773 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
5774 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
5775 @end example
5776 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
5777 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
5778 @end deffn
5779
5780 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis
5781 @cindex kinetis
5782 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
5783 from NXP (former Freescale) include
5784 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
5785 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
5786 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5787 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
5788
5789 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
5790 @itemize
5791 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
5792 @end itemize
5793
5794 @example
5795 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5796 @end example
5797
5798 @deffn Command {kinetis create_banks}
5799 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
5800 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
5801 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
5802 @end deffn
5803
5804 @deffn Command {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
5805 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
5806 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
5807 set by 'flash protect' command.
5808 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
5809 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
5810 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
5811 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
5812 with the rest of a flash image.
5813 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
5814 @end deffn
5815
5816 @deffn Command {kinetis fopt} [num]
5817 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
5818 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
5819 @end deffn
5820
5821 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm check_security}
5822 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
5823 @end deffn
5824
5825 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm halt}
5826 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
5827 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
5828 @end deffn
5829
5830 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
5831 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
5832 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
5833 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
5834 command completes.
5835 @end deffn
5836
5837 @deffn Command {kinetis nvm_partition}
5838 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
5839 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
5840 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
5841 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
5842
5843 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
5844 Program Partition command.
5845
5846 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
5847 Reset the device after partition setting.
5848
5849 Show partition size:
5850 @example
5851 kinetis nvm_partition info
5852 @end example
5853
5854 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
5855 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
5856 @example
5857 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
5858 @end example
5859
5860 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
5861 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
5862 @example
5863 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
5864 @end example
5865 @end deffn
5866
5867 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm reset}
5868 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
5869 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
5870 @end deffn
5871
5872 @deffn Command {kinetis disable_wdog}
5873 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
5874 Command disables watchdog timer.
5875 @end deffn
5876 @end deffn
5877
5878 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis_ke
5879 @cindex kinetis_ke
5880 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
5881 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
5882 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
5883 autoconfigures itself.
5884 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
5885
5886 @example
5887 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5888 @end example
5889
5890 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
5891 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
5892 @end deffn
5893
5894 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
5895 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
5896 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
5897 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
5898 It does not require the processor to be halted.
5899 @end deffn
5900
5901 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
5902 Command disables watchdog timer.
5903 @end deffn
5904 @end deffn
5905
5906 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2000
5907 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
5908 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
5909 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
5910 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
5911
5912 @quotation Note
5913 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
5914 driver:
5915 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
5916 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
5917 @end quotation
5918
5919 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
5920 which must appear in the following order:
5921
5922 @itemize
5923 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
5924 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
5925 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
5926 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
5927 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
5928 LPC43x[2357])
5929 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
5930 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
5931 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
5932 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
5933 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
5934 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
5935 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
5936 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
5937 at which the core is running
5938 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
5939 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
5940 @quotation Note
5941 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
5942 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
5943 However, if you do provide it,
5944 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
5945 @end quotation
5946 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
5947 ROM IAP entry point.
5948 @end itemize
5949
5950 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5951
5952 @example
5953 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
5954 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
5955 @end example
5956
5957 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
5958 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
5959 the specified flash @var{bank}.
5960 @end deffn
5961 @end deffn
5962
5963 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc288x
5964 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
5965 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
5966 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
5967 the programming clock rate in Hz.
5968 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5969
5970 @example
5971 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
5972 @end example
5973 @end deffn
5974
5975 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2900
5976 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
5977 from NXP.
5978
5979 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
5980 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
5981 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
5982 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
5983 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
5984 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
5985 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
5986 you start the PLL.
5987
5988 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
5989
5990 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
5991 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
5992 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
5993
5994 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
5995 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
5996 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
5997 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
5998 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
5999 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
6000 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
6001
6002 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
6003 @example
6004 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
6005 @end example
6006
6007 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
6008 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
6009 @code{flash banks} command.
6010
6011 @deffn Command {lpc2900 signature} bank
6012 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6013 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6014 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6015 a known signature.
6016 Example:
6017 @example
6018 lpc2900 signature 0
6019 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6020 @end example
6021 @end deffn
6022
6023 @deffn Command {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6024 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6025 saves it to a file in binary format.
6026 Example:
6027 @example
6028 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6029 @end example
6030 @end deffn
6031
6032 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
6033 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
6034 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
6035 command:
6036
6037 @deffn Command {lpc2900 password} bank password
6038 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
6039 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
6040 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
6041
6042 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
6043 Example:
6044 @example
6045 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
6046 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
6047 @end example
6048 @end deffn
6049
6050 @deffn Command {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
6051 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
6052 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
6053 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
6054 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
6055 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
6056 912 bytes.
6057 @quotation Attention
6058 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6059 @end quotation
6060 Example:
6061 @example
6062 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
6063 @end example
6064 @end deffn
6065
6066 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
6067 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
6068 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
6069 after the next power cycle.
6070 @quotation Attention
6071 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6072 @end quotation
6073 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
6074 Example:
6075 @example
6076 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
6077 flash info 0
6078 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
6079 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6080 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
6081 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6082 @end example
6083 @end deffn
6084
6085 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
6086 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
6087 effective after the next power cycle.
6088 @quotation Attention
6089 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6090 @end quotation
6091 Examples:
6092 @example
6093 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
6094 @end example
6095 @end deffn
6096 @end deffn
6097
6098 @deffn {Flash Driver} mdr
6099 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
6100 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
6101 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
6102
6103 @example
6104 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
6105 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
6106 @end example
6107
6108 @itemize @bullet
6109 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
6110 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
6111 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
6112 @end itemize
6113
6114 Example usage:
6115 @example
6116 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
6117 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
6118 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
6119 @} else @{
6120 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
6121 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
6122 @}
6123 @end example
6124 @end deffn
6125
6126 @deffn {Flash Driver} msp432
6127 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
6128 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
6129 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
6130 Main program flash (starting at address 0) is flash bank 0. Information flash
6131 region on MSP432P4 versions (starting at address 0x200000) is flash bank 1.
6132
6133 @example
6134 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6135 @end example
6136
6137 @deffn Command {msp432 mass_erase} [main|all]
6138 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
6139 only the main program flash.
6140
6141 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
6142 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
6143 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
6144 @end deffn
6145
6146 @deffn Command {msp432 bsl} [unlock|lock]
6147 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
6148 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
6149 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
6150
6151 To erase and program the BSL:
6152 @example
6153 msp432 bsl unlock
6154 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
6155 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
6156 msp432 bsl lock
6157 @end example
6158 @end deffn
6159 @end deffn
6160
6161 @deffn {Flash Driver} niietcm4
6162 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
6163 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6164 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
6165 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
6166 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
6167 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
6168 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
6169 also have division into regions: main and info.
6170 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
6171 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
6172
6173 @example
6174 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6175 @end example
6176
6177 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
6178
6179 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
6180 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
6181 @end deffn
6182
6183 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
6184 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
6185 @end deffn
6186
6187 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
6188 Erase all userflash including info region.
6189 @end deffn
6190
6191 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
6192 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6193 @end deffn
6194
6195 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
6196 Check sectors protect.
6197 @end deffn
6198
6199 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
6200 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6201 @end deffn
6202
6203 @deffn Command {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
6204 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
6205 @end deffn
6206
6207 @deffn Command {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
6208 Configure external memory interface for boot.
6209 @end deffn
6210
6211 @deffn Command {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
6212 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
6213 @end deffn
6214
6215 @deffn Command {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
6216 Show information about flash driver.
6217 @end deffn
6218
6219 @end deffn
6220
6221 @deffn {Flash Driver} nrf5
6222 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
6223 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
6224 Also, the nRF52832 microcontroller from Nordic Semiconductor, which include
6225 internal flash and use an ARM Cortex-M4F core.
6226
6227 @example
6228 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6229 @end example
6230
6231 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
6232
6233 @deffn Command {nrf5 mass_erase}
6234 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
6235 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
6236 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
6237 code.
6238 @end deffn
6239
6240 @end deffn
6241
6242 @deffn {Flash Driver} ocl
6243 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
6244 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
6245
6246 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
6247 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
6248 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
6249 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
6250
6251 @example
6252 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6253 @end example
6254 @end deffn
6255
6256 @deffn {Flash Driver} pic32mx
6257 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
6258 and integrate flash memory.
6259
6260 @example
6261 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6262 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6263 @end example
6264
6265 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
6266 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6267 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
6268 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
6269 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
6270 @deffn Command {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
6271 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
6272 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
6273 @end deffn
6274 @deffn Command {pic32mx unlock} bank
6275 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
6276 This will remove any Code Protection.
6277 @end deffn
6278 @end deffn
6279
6280 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc4
6281 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
6282 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
6283 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6284 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6285
6286 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
6287 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
6288
6289 @example
6290 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6291 @end example
6292
6293 psoc4-specific commands
6294 @deffn Command {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
6295 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
6296
6297 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
6298 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
6299
6300 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
6301 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
6302 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
6303
6304 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6305 @end deffn
6306
6307 @deffn Command {psoc4 mass_erase} num
6308 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
6309
6310 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6311 @end deffn
6312 @end deffn
6313
6314 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp
6315 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6316 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6317 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6318 apart from the base address.
6319
6320 @example
6321 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6322 @end example
6323
6324 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
6325 @quotation Attention
6326 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
6327 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
6328 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
6329 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
6330 @end quotation
6331
6332 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
6333
6334 @deffn Command {psoc5lp mass_erase}
6335 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
6336 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
6337 @end deffn
6338 @end deffn
6339
6340 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_eeprom
6341 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6342 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6343 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6344 apart from the base address.
6345
6346 @example
6347 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6348 @end example
6349 @end deffn
6350
6351 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_nvl
6352 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6353 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6354 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
6355
6356 @example
6357 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6358 @end example
6359
6360 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
6361
6362 @itemize
6363 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
6364 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
6365 @end itemize
6366
6367 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
6368
6369 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
6370 @quotation Attention
6371 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
6372 after successful write.
6373 @end quotation
6374 @end deffn
6375
6376 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc6
6377 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
6378 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
6379 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
6380
6381 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
6382 @itemize @bullet
6383 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
6384 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
6385 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
6386 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
6387 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
6388 row size: 512 bytes.
6389 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
6390 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
6391 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
6392 operation will erase row automatically.
6393 @end itemize
6394
6395 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
6396 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
6397
6398 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
6399
6400 @example
6401 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6402 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6403 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6404 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6405 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6406 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6407
6408 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6409 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6410 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6411 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6412 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6413 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6414 @end example
6415
6416 psoc6-specific commands
6417 @deffn Command {psoc6 reset_halt}
6418 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
6419 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
6420 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
6421 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
6422 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
6423 @end deffn
6424
6425 @deffn Command {psoc6 mass_erase} num
6426 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
6427 by @command{flash banks}.
6428 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
6429 @end deffn
6430 @end deffn
6431
6432 @deffn {Flash Driver} sim3x
6433 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
6434 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
6435 and SWD interface.
6436 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
6437 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
6438
6439 @example
6440 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6441 @end example
6442
6443 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
6444
6445 @deffn Command {sim3x mass_erase}
6446 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
6447 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
6448 @end deffn
6449
6450 @deffn Command {sim3x lock}
6451 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
6452 @end deffn
6453 @end deffn
6454
6455 @deffn {Flash Driver} stellaris
6456 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
6457 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
6458 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
6459 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6460
6461 @example
6462 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6463 @end example
6464
6465 @deffn Command {stellaris recover}
6466 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
6467 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
6468 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
6469 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
6470 disabled.
6471
6472 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
6473 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
6474 @quotation Warning
6475 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
6476 applied to all of them.
6477 @end quotation
6478 @end deffn
6479 @end deffn
6480
6481 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f1x
6482 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
6483 from STMicroelectronics include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
6484 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6485 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6486
6487 @example
6488 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6489 @end example
6490
6491 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6492 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6493 the flash driver.
6494
6495 @example
6496 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6497 @end example
6498
6499 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
6500 as per the following example.
6501 @example
6502 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6503 @end example
6504
6505 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
6506
6507 @deffn Command {stm32f1x lock} num
6508 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
6509 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6510 @end deffn
6511
6512 @deffn Command {stm32f1x unlock} num
6513 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
6514 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
6515 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6516 @end deffn
6517
6518 @deffn Command {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
6519 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
6520 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6521 @end deffn
6522
6523 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_read} num
6524 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
6525 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
6526 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6527 @end deffn
6528
6529 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP})
6530 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
6531 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6532 @end deffn
6533
6534 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_load} num
6535 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
6536 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
6537 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
6538 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6539 @end deffn
6540 @end deffn
6541
6542 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f2x
6543 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6544 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
6545 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6546 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6547
6548 @example
6549 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6550 @end example
6551
6552 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6553 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6554 the flash driver.
6555
6556 @example
6557 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6558 @end example
6559
6560 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
6561
6562 @deffn Command {stm32f2x lock} num
6563 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6564 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6565 @end deffn
6566
6567 @deffn Command {stm32f2x unlock} num
6568 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6569 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6570 @end deffn
6571
6572 @deffn Command {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
6573 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
6574 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6575 @end deffn
6576
6577 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_read} num
6578 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
6579 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6580 @end deffn
6581
6582 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
6583 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
6584 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
6585 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
6586 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
6587 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
6588 @end deffn
6589
6590 @deffn Command {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
6591 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
6592 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
6593 @end deffn
6594 @end deffn
6595
6596 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32h7x
6597 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6598 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
6599 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6600 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6601
6602 @example
6603 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6604 @end example
6605
6606 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6607 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6608 the flash driver.
6609
6610 @example
6611 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6612 @end example
6613
6614 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
6615
6616 @deffn Command {stm32h7x lock} num
6617 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6618 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6619 @end deffn
6620
6621 @deffn Command {stm32h7x unlock} num
6622 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6623 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6624 @end deffn
6625
6626 @deffn Command {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
6627 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
6628 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6629 @end deffn
6630 @end deffn
6631
6632 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32lx
6633 All members of the STM32L microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6634 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
6635 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6636 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6637
6638 @example
6639 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6640 @end example
6641
6642 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6643 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6644 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
6645 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
6646 second bank.
6647
6648 @example
6649 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6650 @end example
6651
6652 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
6653
6654 @deffn Command {stm32lx lock} num
6655 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6656 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6657 @end deffn
6658
6659 @deffn Command {stm32lx unlock} num
6660 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6661 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6662 @end deffn
6663
6664 @deffn Command {stm32lx mass_erase} num
6665 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
6666 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
6667 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
6668 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6669 @end deffn
6670 @end deffn
6671
6672 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32l4x
6673 All members of the STM32L4 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6674 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6675 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6676 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6677
6678 @example
6679 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6680 @end example
6681
6682 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6683 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6684 the flash driver.
6685
6686 @example
6687 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6688 @end example
6689
6690 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
6691
6692 @deffn Command {stm32l4x lock} num
6693 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6694 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6695 @end deffn
6696
6697 @deffn Command {stm32l4x unlock} num
6698 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6699 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6700 @end deffn
6701
6702 @deffn Command {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
6703 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
6704 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6705 @end deffn
6706
6707 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
6708 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
6709 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
6710 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
6711
6712 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
6713 @example
6714 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
6715 # Option Register: <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
6716 @end example
6717
6718 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
6719 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
6720 @end deffn
6721
6722 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
6723 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
6724 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
6725 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
6726 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
6727
6728 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
6729 @example
6730 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
6731 @end example
6732
6733 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
6734 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
6735 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
6736 @end deffn
6737
6738 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_load} num
6739 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a reset of the device.
6740 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6741 @end deffn
6742 @end deffn
6743
6744 @deffn {Flash Driver} str7x
6745 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
6746 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
6747 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
6748 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
6749
6750 @example
6751 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
6752 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
6753 @end example
6754
6755 @deffn Command {str7x disable_jtag} bank
6756 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
6757 for the specified flash bank.
6758 @end deffn
6759 @end deffn
6760
6761 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9x
6762 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
6763 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
6764 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
6765 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
6766
6767 @example
6768 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6769 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
6770 @end example
6771
6772 @deffn Command {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
6773 Configures the str9 flash controller.
6774 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6775
6776 @itemize @bullet
6777 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
6778 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
6779 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
6780 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
6781 @end itemize
6782 @end deffn
6783
6784 @end deffn
6785
6786 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9xpec
6787 @cindex str9xpec
6788
6789 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
6790 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
6791 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
6792 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
6793
6794 Here is some background info to help
6795 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
6796 the str9:
6797 @enumerate
6798 @item
6799 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
6800 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
6801 @item
6802 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
6803 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
6804 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
6805 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
6806 @end enumerate
6807
6808 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
6809 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
6810 configured for flash bank 0.
6811 @example
6812 # assert srst, we do not want core running
6813 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
6814 jtag_reset 0 1
6815 # turn off target polling
6816 poll off
6817 # disable str9 core
6818 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
6819 # read option bytes
6820 str9xpec options_read 0
6821 # re-enable str9 core
6822 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
6823 poll on
6824 reset halt
6825 @end example
6826 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
6827 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
6828 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
6829 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
6830
6831 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
6832
6833 @deffn Command {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
6834 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
6835 @end deffn
6836
6837 @deffn Command {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
6838 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
6839 directly to the embedded flash controller.
6840 @end deffn
6841
6842 @deffn Command {str9xpec lock} num
6843 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
6844 erase the device.
6845 @end deffn
6846
6847 @deffn Command {str9xpec part_id} num
6848 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
6849 @end deffn
6850
6851 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
6852 Configure str9 boot bank.
6853 @end deffn
6854
6855 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
6856 Configure str9 lvd source.
6857 @end deffn
6858
6859 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
6860 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
6861 @end deffn
6862
6863 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
6864 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
6865 @end deffn
6866
6867 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_read} num
6868 Read str9 option bytes.
6869 @end deffn
6870
6871 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_write} num
6872 Write str9 option bytes.
6873 @end deffn
6874
6875 @deffn Command {str9xpec unlock} num
6876 unlock str9 device.
6877 @end deffn
6878
6879 @end deffn
6880
6881 @deffn {Flash Driver} tms470
6882 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
6883 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
6884 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6885
6886 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
6887
6888 @deffn Command {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
6889 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
6890 @end deffn
6891
6892 @deffn Command {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
6893 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
6894 @end deffn
6895
6896 @deffn Command {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
6897 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
6898 the flash clock.
6899 @end deffn
6900 @end deffn
6901
6902 @deffn {Flash Driver} w600
6903 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
6904 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
6905 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
6906 correct bank config.
6907
6908 @example
6909 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
6910 @end example
6911 @end deffn
6912
6913 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc1xxx
6914 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
6915 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6916 @end deffn
6917
6918 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc4xxx
6919 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
6920 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6921
6922 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
6923
6924 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
6925 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
6926 @end deffn
6927
6928 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
6929 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
6930 @end deffn
6931
6932 @end deffn
6933
6934 @section NAND Flash Commands
6935 @cindex NAND
6936
6937 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
6938 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
6939 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
6940
6941 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
6942 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
6943 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
6944 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
6945 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
6946 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
6947
6948 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
6949 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
6950 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
6951 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
6952 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
6953 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
6954 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
6955 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
6956 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
6957 with techniques such as wear leveling.
6958
6959 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
6960 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
6961 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
6962 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
6963 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
6964 every 512 bytes of data.
6965
6966 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
6967 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
6968 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
6969 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
6970 ECC mode is used.
6971
6972 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
6973 @enumerate
6974 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
6975 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
6976 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
6977 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
6978 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
6979 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
6980 to access that device.
6981 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
6982 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
6983 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
6984 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
6985 de-brick a board.
6986 @end enumerate
6987
6988 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
6989 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
6990 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
6991 are only 32 bits wide.
6992 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
6993 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
6994 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
6995 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
6996
6997 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
6998 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
6999 @cindex NAND configuration
7000
7001 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
7002 plus some additional configuration that's done after
7003 OpenOCD has initialized.
7004
7005 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
7006 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
7007 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
7008 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
7009 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
7010 they were a single (larger) device.
7011 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
7012 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
7013
7014 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
7015 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
7016 configuration files, not interactively.
7017
7018 @itemize @bullet
7019 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
7020 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
7021 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
7022 associated with the NAND device being declared.
7023 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
7024 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
7025 commands to the NAND controller.
7026 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
7027 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
7028 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
7029 for more information.
7030 @end itemize
7031 @end deffn
7032
7033 @deffn Command {nand list}
7034 Prints a summary of each device declared
7035 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
7036 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
7037 @example
7038 > nand list
7039 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7040 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7041 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7042 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7043 >
7044 @end example
7045 @end deffn
7046
7047 @deffn Command {nand probe} num
7048 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
7049 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
7050 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7051 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
7052 it with most other NAND commands.
7053 @end deffn
7054
7055 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
7056
7057 @deffn Command {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
7058 @cindex NAND reading
7059 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
7060 starting at the specified offset.
7061 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7062
7063 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7064 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7065
7066 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
7067 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
7068 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
7069
7070 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
7071 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
7072 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
7073 method which handled that error correction.
7074
7075 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
7076 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
7077 @itemize @bullet
7078 @item no oob_* parameter
7079 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
7080 @item @code{oob_raw}
7081 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
7082 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
7083 spare areas associated with each data page.
7084 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
7085 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
7086 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
7087 @item @code{oob_only}
7088 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
7089 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
7090 spare areas associated with each data page.
7091 @end itemize
7092 @end deffn
7093
7094 @deffn Command {nand erase} num [offset length]
7095 @cindex NAND erasing
7096 @cindex NAND programming
7097 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
7098 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
7099 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7100 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7101 If those parameters are not specified,
7102 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
7103 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7104
7105 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
7106 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
7107 block marker.
7108 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
7109 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
7110 @end deffn
7111
7112 @deffn Command {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
7113 @cindex NAND writing
7114 @cindex NAND programming
7115 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
7116 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
7117 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
7118 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7119
7120 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7121 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7122
7123 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7124 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
7125 past the end of the device.
7126 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
7127 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
7128 if that's being written.)
7129
7130 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
7131 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
7132 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
7133
7134 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
7135 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
7136 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
7137 @itemize @bullet
7138 @item no oob_* parameter
7139 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7140 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
7141 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7142 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
7143 with hardware-computed ECC data.
7144 @item @code{oob_only}
7145 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
7146 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
7147 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
7148 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
7149 @item @code{oob_raw}
7150 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
7151 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
7152 un-altered OOB.
7153 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7154 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
7155 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
7156 @item @code{oob_softecc}
7157 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7158 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
7159 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
7160 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7161 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7162 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
7163 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7164 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
7165 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
7166 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7167 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7168 @end itemize
7169 @end deffn
7170
7171 @deffn Command {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
7172 @cindex NAND verification
7173 @cindex NAND programming
7174 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
7175 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
7176 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7177
7178 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7179 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7180
7181 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7182 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
7183 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
7184 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
7185 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
7186
7187 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
7188 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
7189 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
7190
7191 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
7192 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
7193 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
7194 be removed in a future release.
7195 @end deffn
7196
7197 @subsection Other NAND commands
7198 @cindex NAND other commands
7199
7200 @deffn Command {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
7201 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
7202 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
7203 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
7204 continues for @var{length} bytes.
7205 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7206 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7207 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7208
7209 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
7210 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
7211 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
7212 @end deffn
7213
7214 @deffn Command {nand info} num
7215 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7216 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
7217 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
7218 status for each block.
7219 @end deffn
7220
7221 @deffn Command {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7222 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
7223 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7224
7225 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
7226 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
7227 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
7228 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
7229 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
7230
7231 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
7232 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
7233 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
7234 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
7235 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
7236 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
7237 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
7238 @end deffn
7239
7240 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
7241 @subsection NAND Driver List
7242 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
7243 driver-specific options and behaviors.
7244 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
7245
7246 @deffn {NAND Driver} at91sam9
7247 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
7248 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
7249 address of the ECC controller.
7250 @example
7251 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
7252 @end example
7253 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
7254 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
7255 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
7256 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
7257 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
7258 @deffn Command {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
7259 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
7260 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7261 @end deffn
7262 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
7263 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
7264 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7265 @end deffn
7266
7267 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
7268 properly configured for input or output.
7269 @deffn Command {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
7270 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
7271 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7272 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7273 @end deffn
7274 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
7275 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
7276 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7277 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7278 @end deffn
7279 @end deffn
7280
7281 @deffn {NAND Driver} davinci
7282 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
7283 chips from Texas Instruments.
7284 It takes three extra parameters:
7285 address of the NAND chip;
7286 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
7287 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
7288 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
7289 @example
7290 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
7291 @end example
7292 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
7293 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
7294 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
7295 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
7296 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
7297 @end deffn
7298
7299 @deffn {NAND Driver} lpc3180
7300 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7301 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
7302 @deffn Command {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
7303 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
7304 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
7305 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7306 @end deffn
7307
7308 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
7309 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
7310 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
7311 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
7312 @end deffn
7313 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
7314
7315 @deffn {NAND Driver} mx3
7316 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
7317 should work for this chip as well.
7318 @end deffn
7319
7320 @deffn {NAND Driver} mxc
7321 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
7322 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
7323 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
7324 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
7325 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
7326 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
7327 @example
7328 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
7329 @end example
7330 @deffn Command {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
7331 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
7332 without parameter query status.
7333 @end deffn
7334 @end deffn
7335
7336 @deffn {NAND Driver} orion
7337 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7338 parameter: the address of the controller.
7339 @example
7340 nand device orion 0xd8000000
7341 @end example
7342 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
7343 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7344 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7345 change any behavior.
7346 @end deffn
7347
7348 @deffn {NAND Driver} s3c2410
7349 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2412
7350 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2440
7351 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2443
7352 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c6400
7353 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
7354 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
7355 specialized commands.
7356 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7357 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7358 change any behavior.
7359 @end deffn
7360
7361 @section mFlash
7362
7363 @subsection mFlash Configuration
7364 @cindex mFlash Configuration
7365
7366 @deffn {Config Command} {mflash bank} soc base RST_pin target
7367 Configures a mflash for @var{soc} host bank at
7368 address @var{base}.
7369 The pin number format depends on the host GPIO naming convention.
7370 Currently, the mflash driver supports s3c2440 and pxa270.
7371
7372 Example for s3c2440 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO B1:
7373
7374 @example
7375 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME s3c2440 0x10000000 1b 0
7376 @end example
7377
7378 Example for pxa270 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO 43:
7379
7380 @example
7381 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME pxa270 0x08000000 43 0
7382 @end example
7383 @end deffn
7384
7385 @subsection mFlash commands
7386 @cindex mFlash commands
7387
7388 @deffn Command {mflash config pll} frequency
7389 Configure mflash PLL.
7390 The @var{frequency} is the mflash input frequency, in Hz.
7391 Issuing this command will erase mflash's whole internal nand and write new pll.
7392 After this command, mflash needs power-on-reset for normal operation.
7393 If pll was newly configured, storage and boot(optional) info also need to be update.
7394 @end deffn
7395
7396 @deffn Command {mflash config boot}
7397 Configure bootable option.
7398 If bootable option is set, mflash offer the first 8 sectors
7399 (4kB) for boot.
7400 @end deffn
7401
7402 @deffn Command {mflash config storage}
7403 Configure storage information.
7404 For the normal storage operation, this information must be
7405 written.
7406 @end deffn
7407
7408 @deffn Command {mflash dump} num filename offset size
7409 Dump @var{size} bytes, starting at @var{offset} bytes from the
7410 beginning of the bank @var{num}, to the file named @var{filename}.
7411 @end deffn
7412
7413 @deffn Command {mflash probe}
7414 Probe mflash.
7415 @end deffn
7416
7417 @deffn Command {mflash write} num filename offset
7418 Write the binary file @var{filename} to mflash bank @var{num}, starting at
7419 @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank.
7420 @end deffn
7421
7422 @node Flash Programming
7423 @chapter Flash Programming
7424
7425 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
7426 Programming can be achieved by either using GDB @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
7427 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
7428
7429 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
7430 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
7431
7432 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
7433 @enumerate
7434 @item 'init' is executed.
7435 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
7436 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
7437 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
7438 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
7439 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
7440 @end enumerate
7441
7442 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
7443
7444 @example
7445 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
7446 # are optional parameters
7447 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7448 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
7449
7450 # binary files need the flash address passing
7451 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7452 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
7453 @end example
7454
7455 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
7456 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
7457 @cindex PLD
7458 @cindex FPGA
7459
7460 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
7461 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
7462 OpenOCD can support programming them.
7463 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
7464 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
7465 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
7466 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
7467
7468 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
7469
7470 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
7471 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
7472 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
7473
7474 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
7475 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
7476
7477 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
7478 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
7479 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
7480 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
7481 behavior.
7482 @end deffn
7483
7484 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
7485 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
7486 @end deffn
7487
7488 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
7489 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
7490 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
7491 @end deffn
7492
7493 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
7494
7495 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
7496 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
7497 that particular type of PLD.
7498
7499 @deffn {FPGA Driver} virtex2 [no_jstart]
7500 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
7501 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
7502
7503 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
7504 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
7505 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
7506
7507 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
7508 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
7509 for FPGA @var{num}.
7510 @end deffn
7511 @end deffn
7512
7513 @node General Commands
7514 @chapter General Commands
7515 @cindex commands
7516
7517 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
7518 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
7519 commands are documented elsewhere.
7520
7521 Intent:
7522 @itemize @bullet
7523 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
7524 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
7525 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
7526 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
7527
7528 @item @b{From the human}
7529 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
7530 or via GDB (default port 3333).
7531
7532 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
7533 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
7534 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
7535
7536 @item @b{Machine Interface}
7537 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
7538 port is 5555.
7539 @end itemize
7540
7541
7542 @section Server Commands
7543
7544 @deffn {Command} exit
7545 Exits the current telnet session.
7546 @end deffn
7547
7548 @deffn {Command} help [string]
7549 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
7550 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
7551 Not every command provides helptext.
7552
7553 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
7554 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
7555 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
7556 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
7557 @end deffn
7558
7559 @deffn Command sleep msec [@option{busy}]
7560 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
7561 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
7562 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
7563 Useful in connection with script files
7564 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
7565 @end deffn
7566
7567 @deffn Command shutdown [@option{error}]
7568 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
7569 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
7570 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
7571
7572 Like any TCL commands, also @command{shutdown} can be redefined, e.g.:
7573 @example
7574 # redefine shutdown
7575 rename shutdown original_shutdown
7576 proc shutdown @{@} @{
7577 puts "This is my implementation of shutdown"
7578 # my own stuff before exit OpenOCD
7579 original_shutdown
7580 @}
7581 @end example
7582 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, either the command @command{shutdown}
7583 or its replacement will be automatically executed before OpenOCD exits.
7584 @end deffn
7585
7586 @anchor{debuglevel}
7587 @deffn Command debug_level [n]
7588 @cindex message level
7589 Display debug level.
7590 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
7591 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
7592 Level 0 is error messages only;
7593 level 1 adds warnings;
7594 level 2 adds informational messages;
7595 level 3 adds debugging messages;
7596 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
7597 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
7598 the command line along with the location of that log
7599 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
7600 @xref{Running}.
7601 @end deffn
7602
7603 @deffn Command echo [-n] message
7604 Logs a message at "user" priority.
7605 Output @var{message} to stdout.
7606 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
7607 @example
7608 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
7609 @end example
7610 @end deffn
7611
7612 @deffn Command log_output [filename]
7613 Redirect logging to @var{filename};
7614 the initial log output channel is stderr.
7615 @end deffn
7616
7617 @deffn Command add_script_search_dir [directory]
7618 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
7619 @end deffn
7620
7621 @deffn Command bindto [@var{name}]
7622 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
7623 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
7624 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
7625 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
7626 @end deffn
7627
7628 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
7629 @section Target State handling
7630 @cindex reset
7631 @cindex halt
7632 @cindex target initialization
7633
7634 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
7635 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
7636 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
7637 a current target which is used to perform the
7638 various operations. The current target may be changed
7639 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
7640 target which should become current.
7641
7642 @deffn Command reg [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
7643 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
7644 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
7645 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
7646 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
7647
7648 @emph{With no arguments}:
7649 list all available registers for the current target,
7650 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
7651 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
7652 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
7653 are flagged as such.
7654
7655 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
7656 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
7657 bypassing any internal cache.
7658
7659 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
7660 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
7661 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
7662 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
7663 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
7664 relevant module will flush such values.
7665
7666 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
7667 Debug and trace infrastructure:
7668
7669 @example
7670 > reg
7671 ===== ARM registers
7672 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
7673 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
7674 (2) r2 (/32)
7675 ...
7676 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
7677 >
7678 @end example
7679 @end deffn
7680
7681 @deffn Command halt [ms]
7682 @deffnx Command wait_halt [ms]
7683 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
7684 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
7685 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
7686 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
7687 (and enter debug mode).
7688 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
7689
7690 @quotation Warning
7691 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
7692 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
7693 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
7694 power mode by gating the core clock;
7695 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
7696
7697 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
7698 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
7699 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
7700 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
7701 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
7702 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
7703
7704 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
7705 work with a JTAG debugger.
7706 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
7707 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
7708 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
7709 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
7710 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
7711 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
7712 @end quotation
7713
7714 @end deffn
7715
7716 @deffn Command resume [address]
7717 Resume the target at its current code position,
7718 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
7719 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
7720 @end deffn
7721
7722 @deffn Command step [address]
7723 Single-step the target at its current code position,
7724 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
7725 @end deffn
7726
7727 @anchor{resetcommand}
7728 @deffn Command reset
7729 @deffnx Command {reset run}
7730 @deffnx Command {reset halt}
7731 @deffnx Command {reset init}
7732 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
7733 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
7734 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
7735
7736 The optional parameter specifies what should
7737 happen after the reset.
7738 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
7739 The other options will not work on all systems.
7740 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
7741
7742 @itemize @minus
7743 @item @b{run} Let the target run
7744 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
7745 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
7746 @end itemize
7747 @end deffn
7748
7749 @deffn Command soft_reset_halt
7750 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
7751 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
7752 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
7753 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
7754 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
7755 state.
7756 @end deffn
7757
7758 @section I/O Utilities
7759
7760 These commands are available when
7761 OpenOCD is built with @option{--enable-ioutil}.
7762 They are mainly useful on embedded targets,
7763 notably the ZY1000.
7764 Hosts with operating systems have complementary tools.
7765
7766 @emph{Note:} there are several more such commands.
7767
7768 @deffn Command append_file filename [string]*
7769 Appends the @var{string} parameters to
7770 the text file @file{filename}.
7771 Each string except the last one is followed by one space.
7772 The last string is followed by a newline.
7773 @end deffn
7774
7775 @deffn Command cat filename
7776 Reads and displays the text file @file{filename}.
7777 @end deffn
7778
7779 @deffn Command cp src_filename dest_filename
7780 Copies contents from the file @file{src_filename}
7781 into @file{dest_filename}.
7782 @end deffn
7783
7784 @deffn Command ip
7785 @emph{No description provided.}
7786 @end deffn
7787
7788 @deffn Command ls
7789 @emph{No description provided.}
7790 @end deffn
7791
7792 @deffn Command mac
7793 @emph{No description provided.}
7794 @end deffn
7795
7796 @deffn Command meminfo
7797 Display available RAM memory on OpenOCD host.
7798 Used in OpenOCD regression testing scripts.
7799 @end deffn
7800
7801 @deffn Command peek
7802 @emph{No description provided.}
7803 @end deffn
7804
7805 @deffn Command poke
7806 @emph{No description provided.}
7807 @end deffn
7808
7809 @deffn Command rm filename
7810 @c "rm" has both normal and Jim-level versions??
7811 Unlinks the file @file{filename}.
7812 @end deffn
7813
7814 @deffn Command trunc filename
7815 Removes all data in the file @file{filename}.
7816 @end deffn
7817
7818 @anchor{memoryaccess}
7819 @section Memory access commands
7820 @cindex memory access
7821
7822 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
7823 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
7824 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
7825 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
7826
7827 @enumerate
7828 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
7829 to change the current target.
7830 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
7831 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
7832 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
7833 @end enumerate
7834
7835 @deffn Command mdw [phys] addr [count]
7836 @deffnx Command mdh [phys] addr [count]
7837 @deffnx Command mdb [phys] addr [count]
7838 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
7839 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
7840 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
7841 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
7842 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
7843 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
7844 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
7845 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
7846 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
7847 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
7848 @end deffn
7849
7850 @deffn Command mww [phys] addr word
7851 @deffnx Command mwh [phys] addr halfword
7852 @deffnx Command mwb [phys] addr byte
7853 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
7854 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
7855 at the specified address @var{addr}.
7856 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
7857 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
7858 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
7859 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
7860 @end deffn
7861
7862 @anchor{imageaccess}
7863 @section Image loading commands
7864 @cindex image loading
7865 @cindex image dumping
7866
7867 @deffn Command {dump_image} filename address size
7868 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
7869 binary file named @var{filename}.
7870 @end deffn
7871
7872 @deffn Command {fast_load}
7873 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
7874 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
7875 @end deffn
7876
7877 @deffn Command {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
7878 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
7879 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
7880 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
7881 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
7882 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
7883 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
7884 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
7885 separately.
7886 @end deffn
7887
7888 @deffn Command {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
7889 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
7890 The file format may optionally be specified
7891 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
7892 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
7893 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
7894 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
7895 @example
7896 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
7897 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
7898 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
7899 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
7900 $address $length
7901 @}
7902 @end example
7903 @end deffn
7904
7905 @deffn Command {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
7906 Displays image section sizes and addresses
7907 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
7908 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
7909 The file format may optionally be specified
7910 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
7911 @end deffn
7912
7913 @deffn Command {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
7914 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
7915 The file format may optionally be specified
7916 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
7917 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
7918 @end deffn
7919
7920 @deffn Command {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
7921 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
7922 The file format may optionally be specified
7923 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
7924 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
7925 @end deffn
7926
7927
7928 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
7929 @cindex breakpoint
7930 @cindex watchpoint
7931
7932 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
7933 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
7934 watchpoints.
7935 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
7936
7937 @deffn Command {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
7938 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
7939 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
7940 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
7941 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
7942 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
7943
7944 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
7945 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
7946 @end deffn
7947
7948 @deffn Command {rbp} address
7949 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address}.
7950 @end deffn
7951
7952 @deffn Command {rwp} address
7953 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
7954 @end deffn
7955
7956 @deffn Command {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
7957 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
7958 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
7959 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
7960 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
7961 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
7962 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
7963 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
7964 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
7965 @end deffn
7966
7967 @section Misc Commands
7968
7969 @cindex profiling
7970 @deffn Command {profile} seconds filename [start end]
7971 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
7972 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
7973 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
7974 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
7975 limit the address range.
7976 @end deffn
7977
7978 @deffn Command {version}
7979 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
7980 @end deffn
7981
7982 @deffn Command {virt2phys} virtual_address
7983 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
7984 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
7985 @end deffn
7986
7987 @node Architecture and Core Commands
7988 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
7989 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
7990 @cindex Core Specific Commands
7991
7992 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
7993 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
7994 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
7995 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
7996
7997 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
7998 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
7999 @cindex tracing
8000 @cindex ETM
8001 @cindex ETB
8002
8003 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
8004 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
8005 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
8006
8007 @itemize
8008 @item
8009 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
8010 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
8011 supports such an interface.
8012 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
8013 and trace port support.)
8014 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
8015 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
8016 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
8017 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
8018 in the board-specific configuration file.
8019 @item
8020 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
8021 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
8022 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
8023 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
8024 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
8025 @end itemize
8026
8027 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
8028
8029 @quotation Issues
8030 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
8031 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
8032
8033 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
8034 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
8035 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
8036 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
8037 dummy trace port driver}.
8038
8039 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
8040 as well as tracing only during specific states
8041 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
8042
8043 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
8044 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
8045 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
8046 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
8047 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
8048
8049 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
8050 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
8051 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
8052 this original style of JTAG access.
8053 @end quotation
8054
8055 @subsection ETM Configuration
8056 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
8057
8058 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
8059 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
8060 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
8061
8062 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
8063 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
8064 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
8065 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
8066 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
8067 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
8068 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
8069 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
8070 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
8071
8072 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
8073 or @option{demultiplexed}.
8074 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
8075
8076 @quotation Warning
8077 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
8078 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
8079 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
8080 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
8081 @end quotation
8082
8083 @quotation Note
8084 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
8085 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
8086 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
8087 what CPU activities are traced.
8088 @end quotation
8089 @end deffn
8090
8091 @deffn Command {etm info}
8092 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
8093 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
8094 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
8095 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
8096 @end deffn
8097
8098 @deffn Command {etm status}
8099 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
8100 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
8101 Did trace data overflow?
8102 Was it triggered?
8103 @end deffn
8104
8105 @deffn Command {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
8106 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
8107 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
8108 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
8109 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
8110
8111 @itemize
8112 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
8113 when they pass any ViewData filtering that that was set up.
8114 The value is one of
8115 @option{none} (save nothing),
8116 @option{data} (save data),
8117 @option{address} (save addresses),
8118 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
8119 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
8120 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
8121 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
8122 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
8123 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
8124 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
8125 trace stream without an image of the code.
8126 @end itemize
8127 @end deffn
8128
8129 @deffn Command {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8130 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
8131 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
8132 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
8133 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
8134
8135 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
8136 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
8137 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
8138 @end deffn
8139
8140 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
8141
8142 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
8143 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
8144 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
8145
8146 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
8147 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
8148 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
8149 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
8150 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
8151 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
8152 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
8153
8154 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
8155
8156 @itemize
8157 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
8158 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
8159 for instruction access within that function's body.
8160 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
8161 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
8162 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
8163 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
8164 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
8165 combining one of the above models with a counter.
8166 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
8167 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
8168 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
8169 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
8170 @item @emph{... more}
8171 @end itemize
8172
8173 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
8174 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
8175
8176 @deffn Command {etm analyze}
8177 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
8178 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
8179 @end deffn
8180
8181 @deffn Command {etm dump} filename
8182 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
8183 @end deffn
8184
8185 @deffn Command {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
8186 Opens an image file.
8187 @end deffn
8188
8189 @deffn Command {etm load} filename
8190 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
8191 @end deffn
8192
8193 @deffn Command {etm start}
8194 Starts trace data collection.
8195 @end deffn
8196
8197 @deffn Command {etm stop}
8198 Stops trace data collection.
8199 @end deffn
8200
8201 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
8202 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
8203
8204 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
8205
8206 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} dummy
8207 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8208 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
8209 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
8210 any trace data collection.}
8211 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
8212 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
8213 @end deffn
8214 @end deffn
8215
8216 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} etb
8217 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
8218 to use on-chip ETB memory.
8219 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
8220 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
8221 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
8222 @end deffn
8223 @deffn Command {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
8224 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
8225 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
8226 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
8227 trace trigger becomes active.
8228
8229 @itemize
8230 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
8231 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
8232 afterwards.
8233 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
8234 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
8235 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
8236 what caused that event to happen.
8237 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
8238 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
8239 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
8240 how the event caused trouble.
8241 @end itemize
8242 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
8243 @end deffn
8244
8245 @end deffn
8246
8247 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} oocd_trace
8248 This driver isn't available unless OpenOCD was explicitly configured
8249 with the @option{--enable-oocd_trace} option. You probably don't want
8250 to configure it unless you've built the appropriate prototype hardware;
8251 it's @emph{proof-of-concept} software.
8252
8253 Use the @option{oocd_trace} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8254 connected to an off-chip trace connector.
8255
8256 @deffn {Config Command} {oocd_trace config} target tty
8257 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a trace driver which
8258 collects data through the serial port @var{tty}.
8259 @end deffn
8260
8261 @deffn Command {oocd_trace resync}
8262 Re-synchronizes with the capture clock.
8263 @end deffn
8264
8265 @deffn Command {oocd_trace status}
8266 Reports whether the capture clock is locked or not.
8267 @end deffn
8268 @end deffn
8269
8270 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
8271 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
8272 @cindex CTI
8273
8274 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
8275 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
8276 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
8277 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
8278 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
8279 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
8280
8281 @deffn Command {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-ctibase} base_address
8282 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
8283 @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
8284 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
8285 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
8286 including additional configuration.
8287 @end deffn
8288
8289 @deffn Command {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
8290 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
8291 @end deffn
8292
8293 @deffn Command {$cti_name dump}
8294 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
8295 @end deffn
8296
8297 @deffn Command {$cti_name write } @var{reg_name} @var{value}
8298 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8299 @end deffn
8300
8301 @deffn Command {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
8302 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8303 @end deffn
8304
8305 @deffn Command {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
8306 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
8307 of the CTI.
8308 @end deffn
8309
8310 @deffn Command {cti names}
8311 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
8312 useful in TCL scripting.
8313 @end deffn
8314
8315 @section Generic ARM
8316 @cindex ARM
8317
8318 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
8319 They are available in addition to other core-specific
8320 commands that may be available.
8321
8322 @deffn Command {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
8323 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
8324 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
8325 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
8326 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8327 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
8328 @end deffn
8329
8330 @deffn Command {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
8331 @cindex disassemble
8332 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
8333 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
8334 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
8335 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
8336 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
8337 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8338 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
8339
8340 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
8341 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
8342 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
8343 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
8344 with a handful of exceptions.
8345 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
8346 @end deffn
8347
8348 @deffn Command {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
8349 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
8350 passing parameters @var{CRn},
8351 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8352 and using the MCR instruction.
8353 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8354 an ARM register.)
8355 @end deffn
8356
8357 @deffn Command {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
8358 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
8359 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8360 and the MRC instruction.
8361 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
8362 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8363 an ARM register.)
8364 @end deffn
8365
8366 @deffn Command {arm reg}
8367 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
8368 core mode if necessary.
8369 @end deffn
8370
8371 @deffn Command {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8372 @cindex ARM semihosting
8373 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
8374
8375 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
8376 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
8377 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
8378 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
8379 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
8380 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
8381 @end deffn
8382
8383 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8384 @cindex ARM semihosting
8385 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
8386
8387 @example
8388 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
8389 @end example
8390
8391 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
8392 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
8393 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
8394 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
8395 @end deffn
8396
8397 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8398 @cindex ARM semihosting
8399 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
8400 status.
8401
8402 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
8403 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
8404 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
8405 debugger.
8406 @end deffn
8407
8408 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8409 @cindex ARM semihosting
8410 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
8411
8412 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
8413 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
8414 the value returned by the target.
8415
8416 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
8417 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
8418 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
8419 encountering a break.
8420
8421 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
8422 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
8423 to the debugger.
8424 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
8425 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
8426 request or equivalent").
8427
8428 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
8429 this option (default: disabled).
8430 @end deffn
8431
8432 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
8433 @cindex ARMv4
8434 @cindex ARMv5
8435
8436 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
8437 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
8438 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
8439 variant.
8440
8441 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
8442 @cindex ARM7
8443 @cindex ARM9
8444
8445 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
8446 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
8447 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
8448 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
8449
8450 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8451 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
8452 the EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
8453 instead of breakpoints.
8454 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8455
8456 This should be
8457 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
8458 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
8459 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
8460 @end deffn
8461
8462 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8463 @cindex DCC
8464 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
8465 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
8466 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8467
8468 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
8469 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
8470 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
8471 @end deffn
8472
8473 @deffn Command {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8474 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
8475 that don't check completion of the operation.
8476 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8477
8478 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
8479 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
8480 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
8481 @end deffn
8482
8483 @subsection ARM720T specific commands
8484 @cindex ARM720T
8485
8486 These commands are available to ARM720T based CPUs,
8487 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
8488 based on the ARM7TDMI-S integer core.
8489 They are available in addition to the ARM and ARM7/ARM9 commands.
8490
8491 @deffn Command {arm720t cp15} opcode [value]
8492 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
8493 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
8494
8495 Display cp15 register returned by the ARM instruction @var{opcode};
8496 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8497 The @var{opcode} should be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction.
8498 @end deffn
8499
8500 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
8501 @cindex ARM9
8502
8503 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
8504 integer processors.
8505 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
8506
8507 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
8508 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
8509 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
8510 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
8511
8512 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
8513 @deffn Command {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
8514 @cindex vector_catch
8515 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
8516 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
8517 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
8518 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
8519 to those hardware vectors.
8520
8521 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
8522 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
8523 vector catch hardware to intercept
8524 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
8525 @option{none} of them,
8526 or a list with one or more of the following:
8527 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
8528 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
8529 @end deffn
8530
8531 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
8532 @cindex ARM920T
8533
8534 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
8535 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
8536 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
8537 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8538 and ARM9 commands.
8539
8540 @deffn Command {arm920t cache_info}
8541 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
8542 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
8543 @end deffn
8544
8545 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
8546 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8547 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8548 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
8549 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
8550 (Not all registers can be written.)
8551 @end deffn
8552
8553 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15i} opcode [value [address]]
8554 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
8555 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
8556
8557 Interpreted access using ARM instruction @var{opcode}, which should
8558 be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction
8559 (as shown tables 9-11, 9-12, and 9-13 in the ARM920T TRM).
8560 If no @var{value} is provided, the result is displayed.
8561 Else if that value is written using the specified @var{address},
8562 or using zero if no other address is provided.
8563 @end deffn
8564
8565 @deffn Command {arm920t read_cache} filename
8566 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
8567 @end deffn
8568
8569 @deffn Command {arm920t read_mmu} filename
8570 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
8571 @end deffn
8572
8573 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
8574 @cindex ARM926ej-s
8575
8576 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
8577 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
8578 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
8579 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8580 and ARM9 commands.
8581
8582 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
8583 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
8584
8585 @deffn Command {arm926ejs cache_info}
8586 Print information about the caches found.
8587 @end deffn
8588
8589 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
8590 @cindex ARM966E
8591
8592 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
8593 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
8594 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8595 and ARM9 commands.
8596
8597 @deffn Command {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
8598 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8599 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8600 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
8601 ARM966E-S TRM.
8602 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
8603 as required for BIST support.
8604 @end deffn
8605
8606 @subsection XScale specific commands
8607 @cindex XScale
8608
8609 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
8610
8611 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
8612 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
8613 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
8614 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
8615 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
8616 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
8617 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
8618
8619 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
8620 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
8621 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
8622 the mini-IC.
8623
8624 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
8625 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
8626 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
8627 code layout in memory:
8628 @example
8629 _vectors:
8630 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8631 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8632 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8633 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8634 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8635 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8636 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8637 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8638 .org 0x100
8639 .long real_reset_vector
8640 .long real_ui_handler
8641 .long real_swi_handler
8642 .long real_pf_abort
8643 .long real_data_abort
8644 .long 0 /* unused */
8645 .long real_irq_handler
8646 .long real_fiq_handler
8647 @end example
8648
8649 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
8650 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
8651 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
8652 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
8653 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
8654 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
8655 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
8656 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
8657 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
8658 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
8659 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
8660 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
8661 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
8662 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
8663 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
8664 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
8665 software.
8666
8667 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
8668 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
8669 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
8670 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
8671
8672 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
8673 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
8674 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
8675 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
8676 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
8677 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
8678 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
8679 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
8680 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
8681
8682 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
8683 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
8684
8685 @deffn Command {xscale analyze_trace}
8686 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
8687 @end deffn
8688
8689 @deffn Command {xscale cache_clean_address} address
8690 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
8691 @end deffn
8692
8693 @deffn Command {xscale cache_info}
8694 Displays information about the CPU caches.
8695 @end deffn
8696
8697 @deffn Command {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
8698 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8699 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8700 @end deffn
8701
8702 @deffn Command {xscale debug_handler} target address
8703 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
8704 @end deffn
8705
8706 @deffn Command {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8707 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
8708 @end deffn
8709
8710 @deffn Command {xscale dump_trace} filename
8711 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
8712 @end deffn
8713
8714 @deffn Command {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8715 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
8716 @end deffn
8717
8718 @deffn Command {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8719 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
8720 @end deffn
8721
8722 @deffn Command {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
8723 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
8724 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
8725 and modifying how it is emptied.
8726 @end deffn
8727
8728 @deffn Command {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
8729 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
8730 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
8731 The image @var{type} may be one of
8732 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
8733 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
8734 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
8735 @end deffn
8736
8737 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
8738 @deffn Command {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
8739 @cindex vector_catch
8740 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
8741 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
8742
8743 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
8744 @example
8745 0x01 Trap Reset
8746 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
8747 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
8748 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
8749 0x10 Trap Data Abort
8750 0x20 reserved
8751 0x40 Trap IRQ
8752 0x80 Trap FIQ
8753 @end example
8754 @end deffn
8755
8756 @deffn Command {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
8757 @cindex vector_table
8758
8759 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
8760 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
8761 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
8762 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
8763 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
8764
8765 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
8766
8767 @end deffn
8768
8769 @section ARMv6 Architecture
8770 @cindex ARMv6
8771
8772 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
8773 @cindex ARM11
8774
8775 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8776 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
8777 which is enabled by default.
8778 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8779 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
8780 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
8781 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
8782 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
8783 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
8784 @end deffn
8785
8786 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8787 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
8788 which is enabled by default.
8789 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8790 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
8791 @end deffn
8792
8793 @deffn Command {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8794 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
8795 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
8796 they are disabled by default.
8797 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
8798 @end deffn
8799
8800 @deffn Command {arm11 vcr} [value]
8801 @cindex vector_catch
8802 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
8803 coprocessor 14 register 7.
8804 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
8805
8806 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
8807 for certain hardware events.
8808 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
8809 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
8810 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
8811 @end deffn
8812
8813 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
8814 @cindex ARMv7
8815 @cindex ARMv8
8816
8817 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
8818 @cindex Cortex-A
8819
8820 @deffn Command {cortex_a cache_info}
8821 display information about target caches
8822 @end deffn
8823
8824 @deffn Command {cortex_a dacrfixup [@option{on}|@option{off}]}
8825 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
8826 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
8827 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
8828 Defaults to 'off'.
8829 @end deffn
8830
8831 @deffn Command {cortex_a dbginit}
8832 Initialize core debug
8833 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
8834 @end deffn
8835
8836 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_off}
8837 Disable SMP mode
8838 @end deffn
8839
8840 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_on}
8841 Enable SMP mode
8842 @end deffn
8843
8844 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
8845 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
8846 @end deffn
8847
8848 @deffn Command {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
8849 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
8850 @end deffn
8851
8852 @deffn Command {cache_config l2x} [base way]
8853 configure l2x cache
8854 @end deffn
8855
8856 @deffn Command {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
8857 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
8858 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
8859 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
8860 possible (4096) entries are printed.
8861 @end deffn
8862
8863 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
8864 @cindex Cortex-R
8865
8866 @deffn Command {cortex_r dbginit}
8867 Initialize core debug
8868 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
8869 @end deffn
8870
8871 @deffn Command {cortex_r maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
8872 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
8873 @end deffn
8874
8875
8876 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
8877 @cindex tracing
8878 @cindex SWO
8879 @cindex SWV
8880 @cindex TPIU
8881 @cindex ITM
8882 @cindex ETM
8883
8884 @deffn Command {tpiu config} (@option{disable} | ((@option{external} | @option{internal (@var{filename} | -)}) @
8885 (@option{sync @var{port_width}} | ((@option{manchester} | @option{uart}) @var{formatter_enable})) @
8886 @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} [@var{trace_freq}]))
8887
8888 ARMv7-M architecture provides several modules to generate debugging
8889 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
8890 through TPIU to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
8891 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
8892
8893 This command configures the TPIU module of the target and, if internal
8894 capture mode is selected, starts to capture trace output by using the
8895 debugger adapter features.
8896
8897 Some targets require additional actions to be performed in the
8898 @b{trace-config} handler for trace port to be activated.
8899
8900 Command options:
8901 @itemize @minus
8902 @item @option{disable} disable TPIU handling;
8903 @item @option{external} configure TPIU to let user capture trace
8904 output externally (with an additional UART or logic analyzer hardware);
8905 @item @option{internal @var{filename}} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
8906 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename} (which can be
8907 either a regular file or a named pipe);
8908 @item @option{internal -} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
8909 gather trace data, but not write to any file. Useful in conjunction with the @command{tcl_trace} command;
8910 @item @option{sync @var{port_width}} use synchronous parallel trace output
8911 mode, and set port width to @var{port_width};
8912 @item @option{manchester} use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester
8913 coding;
8914 @item @option{uart} use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as
8915 regular UART 8N1) coding;
8916 @item @var{formatter_enable} is @option{on} or @option{off} to enable
8917 or disable TPIU formatter which needs to be used when both ITM and ETM
8918 data is to be output via SWO;
8919 @item @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} this should be specified to match target's
8920 current TRACECLKIN frequency (usually the same as HCLK);
8921 @item @var{trace_freq} trace port frequency. Can be omitted in
8922 internal mode to let the adapter driver select the maximum supported
8923 rate automatically.
8924 @end itemize
8925
8926 Example usage:
8927 @enumerate
8928 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
8929 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
8930 enough to:
8931 @example
8932 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
8933 ...
8934 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
8935 ...
8936 @end example
8937 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
8938 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
8939 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
8940 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
8941 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
8942 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
8943 @example
8944 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
8945 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
8946 @end example
8947 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
8948 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
8949 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
8950 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
8951 @example
8952 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
8953 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
8954 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
8955 -c "tpiu config external uart off 24000000 12000000"
8956 @end example
8957 @end enumerate
8958 @end deffn
8959
8960 @deffn Command {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
8961 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
8962 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
8963 @end deffn
8964
8965 @deffn Command {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
8966 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
8967 @end deffn
8968
8969 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
8970 @cindex Cortex-M
8971
8972 @deffn Command {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off})
8973 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
8974
8975 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
8976 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
8977 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
8978 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
8979 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
8980 the step command leaves with the core running.
8981
8982 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
8983 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
8984 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
8985 does.
8986
8987 Default is @option{auto}.
8988 @end deffn
8989
8990 @deffn Command {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
8991 @cindex vector_catch
8992 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
8993 for certain hardware events.
8994
8995 Parameters request interception of
8996 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
8997 @option{none} of them,
8998 or one or more of the following:
8999 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
9000 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
9001 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
9002 @option{irq_err},
9003 @option{state_err},
9004 @option{chk_err}, or
9005 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
9006 @option{reset}.
9007 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
9008 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
9009 are mapped to HardFault.
9010 UsageFault checks for
9011 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
9012 must also be explicitly enabled.
9013
9014 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
9015 @end deffn
9016
9017 @deffn Command {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
9018 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
9019 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
9020
9021 @itemize @minus
9022 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
9023 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
9024 @end itemize
9025
9026 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
9027 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
9028 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
9029 to manually reset the peripherals.
9030 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
9031
9032 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
9033 instead.
9034 @end deffn
9035
9036 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
9037 @cindex ARMv8-A
9038 @cindex aarch64
9039
9040 @deffn Command {aarch64 cache_info}
9041 Display information about target caches
9042 @end deffn
9043
9044 @deffn Command {aarch64 dbginit}
9045 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
9046 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
9047 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
9048 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
9049 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
9050 @end deffn
9051
9052 @deffn Command {aarch64 smp_on|smp_off}
9053 Enable and disable SMP handling. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
9054 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
9055 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
9056 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
9057 @end deffn
9058
9059 @deffn Command {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9060 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
9061 @option{on}.
9062 @end deffn
9063
9064 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
9065
9066 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
9067 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
9068
9069 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
9070
9071 @deffn Command {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
9072 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
9073 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
9074 @end deffn
9075
9076 @deffn Command {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
9077 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
9078 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
9079 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
9080 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
9081 @end deffn
9082
9083 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
9084
9085 @deffn Command {esirisc flush_caches}
9086 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
9087 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
9088 @end deffn
9089
9090 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
9091
9092 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
9093 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
9094 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
9095 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
9096 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
9097 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
9098 can be collected.
9099
9100 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
9101 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
9102 tooling.
9103
9104 @quotation Issues
9105 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
9106 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
9107 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
9108 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
9109
9110 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
9111 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
9112 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
9113 software operation on the CPU.
9114 @end quotation
9115
9116 @deffn Command {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
9117 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
9118 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
9119 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
9120 @end deffn
9121
9122 @deffn Command {esirisc trace fifo} address
9123 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
9124 @end deffn
9125
9126 @deffn Command {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9127 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
9128 control is disabled.
9129 @end deffn
9130
9131 @deffn Command {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
9132 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
9133 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
9134 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
9135
9136 Supported trace formats:
9137 @itemize
9138 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
9139 timing to be determined.
9140 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
9141 addresses.
9142 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
9143 @end itemize
9144 @end deffn
9145
9146 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
9147 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
9148 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
9149 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9150
9151 Supported conditions:
9152 @itemize
9153 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
9154 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
9155 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
9156 instruction matches start data and mask.
9157 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
9158 instruction matches start data and mask.
9159 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
9160 data and mask.
9161 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9162 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9163 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9164 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
9165 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
9166 @end itemize
9167 @end deffn
9168
9169 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
9170 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
9171 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
9172 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9173
9174 Supported conditions:
9175 @itemize
9176 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
9177 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
9178 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
9179 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9180 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
9181 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9182 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
9183 data and mask.
9184 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9185 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9186 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9187 @end itemize
9188 @end deffn
9189
9190 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
9191 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
9192
9193 Supported triggers:
9194 @itemize
9195 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
9196 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
9197 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
9198 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
9199 collection.
9200 @end itemize
9201 @end deffn
9202
9203 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
9204
9205 @deffn Command {esirisc trace init}
9206 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
9207 configuration changes. If an trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
9208 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
9209 @end deffn
9210
9211 @deffn Command {esirisc trace info}
9212 Display trace configuration.
9213 @end deffn
9214
9215 @deffn Command {esirisc trace status}
9216 Display trace collection status.
9217 @end deffn
9218
9219 @deffn Command {esirisc trace start}
9220 Start manual trace collection.
9221 @end deffn
9222
9223 @deffn Command {esirisc trace stop}
9224 Stop manual trace collection.
9225 @end deffn
9226
9227 @deffn Command {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
9228 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
9229 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
9230 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9231 @option{size} options using DMA.
9232 @end deffn
9233
9234 @deffn Command {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
9235 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
9236 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
9237 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9238 @option{size} options using DMA.
9239 @end deffn
9240
9241 @section Intel Architecture
9242
9243 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
9244 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
9245 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
9246 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
9247 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
9248 @itemize
9249 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
9250 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
9251 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
9252 @end itemize
9253
9254 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
9255 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
9256 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
9257
9258 @deffn Command {x86_32 idw} address
9259 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9260 @end deffn
9261
9262 @deffn Command {x86_32 idh} address
9263 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9264 @end deffn
9265
9266 @deffn Command {x86_32 idb} address
9267 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9268 @end deffn
9269
9270 @deffn Command {x86_32 iww} address
9271 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9272 @end deffn
9273
9274 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwh} address
9275 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9276 @end deffn
9277
9278 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwb} address
9279 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9280 @end deffn
9281
9282 @section OpenRISC Architecture
9283
9284 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
9285 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
9286
9287 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
9288 @deffn Command {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
9289 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
9290 @end deffn
9291 @deffn Command {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
9292 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
9293
9294 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
9295
9296 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
9297 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
9298 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
9299 @end deffn
9300
9301 @subsection Registers commands
9302 @deffn Command {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
9303 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
9304 included in the generated target descriptor file.
9305
9306 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
9307
9308 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
9309 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
9310 and "timer" groups.
9311
9312 @emph{example:}
9313 @example
9314 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
9315 @end example
9316
9317
9318 @end deffn
9319 @deffn Command {readgroup} (@option{group})
9320 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
9321
9322 @emph{group} can be "system",
9323 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
9324 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
9325 @end deffn
9326
9327 @section RISC-V Architecture
9328
9329 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
9330 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
9331 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
9332 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
9333 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
9334 implement version 0.11.
9335
9336 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
9337
9338 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
9339 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
9340 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
9341
9342 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
9343
9344 @deffn Command {riscv expose_csrs} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
9345 Configure a list of inclusive ranges for CSRs to expose in addition to the
9346 standard ones. This must be executed before `init`.
9347
9348 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
9349 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
9350 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or a target implements custom
9351 CSRs.
9352 @end deffn
9353
9354 @deffn Command {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9355 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
9356 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
9357 @end deffn
9358
9359 @deffn Command {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9360 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
9361 deasserted.
9362 @end deffn
9363
9364 @deffn Command {riscv set_scratch_ram} none|[address]
9365 Set the address of 16 bytes of scratch RAM the debugger can use, or 'none'.
9366 This is used to access 64-bit floating point registers on 32-bit targets.
9367 @end deffn
9368
9369 @deffn Command {riscv set_prefer_sba} on|off
9370 When on, prefer to use System Bus Access to access memory. When off, prefer to
9371 use the Program Buffer to access memory.
9372 @end deffn
9373
9374 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
9375
9376 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
9377 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
9378 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
9379 @example
9380 set challenge [ocd_riscv authdata_read]
9381 riscv authdata_write [expr $challenge + 1]
9382 @end example
9383
9384 @deffn Command {riscv authdata_read}
9385 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata. Note that to get read value back in
9386 a TCL script, it needs to be invoked as @command{ocd_riscv authdata_read}.
9387 @end deffn
9388
9389 @deffn Command {riscv authdata_write} value
9390 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
9391 @end deffn
9392
9393 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
9394
9395 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
9396 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
9397
9398 @deffn Command {riscv dmi_read}
9399 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value. Note that to get
9400 read value back in a TCL script, it needs to be invoked as @command{ocd_riscv
9401 dmi_read}.
9402 @end deffn
9403
9404 @deffn Command {riscv dmi_write} address value
9405 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
9406 @end deffn
9407
9408 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
9409 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
9410 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
9411 @cindex tracing
9412 @cindex libdcc
9413 @cindex DCC
9414 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
9415 the target uses appropriate libraries.
9416 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
9417 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
9418
9419 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
9420 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
9421 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
9422 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
9423 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
9424 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
9425
9426 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
9427 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
9428 arrays of various size integers from the target,
9429 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
9430 The target being debugged may
9431 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
9432 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
9433 each supported by a command:
9434
9435 @itemize
9436 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
9437 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
9438 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
9439 finding out how some fault was triggered.
9440
9441 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
9442 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
9443 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
9444
9445 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
9446 and then displayed at any time.
9447 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
9448
9449 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
9450 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
9451 @end itemize
9452
9453 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
9454 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
9455 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
9456 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
9457 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
9458 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
9459 does the same thing.
9460
9461 @deffn Command {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
9462 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
9463 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
9464 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
9465 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
9466
9467 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
9468 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
9469 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
9470 @end deffn
9471
9472 @deffn Command {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
9473 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
9474 in the order they triggered.
9475 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
9476 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
9477 history records.
9478 @end deffn
9479
9480 @deffn Command {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
9481 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
9482 they have been triggered.
9483 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
9484 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
9485 and associates it with that identifier.
9486
9487 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
9488 are not related except by this command.
9489 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
9490 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
9491 @end deffn
9492
9493
9494 @node JTAG Commands
9495 @chapter JTAG Commands
9496 @cindex JTAG Commands
9497 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
9498 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
9499 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
9500 may be needed to work with targets which require special
9501 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
9502
9503 To use these commands you will need to understand some
9504 of the basics of JTAG, including:
9505
9506 @itemize @bullet
9507 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
9508 devices such as a CPUs.
9509 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
9510 standard state machine (in parallel)
9511 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
9512 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
9513 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
9514 while the reading previous ones.
9515 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
9516 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
9517 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
9518 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
9519 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
9520 registers.
9521 @end itemize
9522
9523 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
9524
9525 These commands are used by developers who need to access
9526 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
9527 the order of TAP state transitions.
9528 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
9529 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
9530 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
9531 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
9532 these commands are not available.
9533
9534 @deffn Command {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
9535 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
9536 that specify the entire register.
9537 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
9538 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
9539 The return value holds the original value of each
9540 of those fields.
9541
9542 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
9543 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
9544 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
9545 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
9546 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
9547
9548 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
9549 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
9550
9551 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
9552 in that state.
9553 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
9554 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
9555 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
9556
9557 @quotation Warning
9558 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
9559 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
9560 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
9561 data registers, which may have different lengths.
9562 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
9563 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
9564 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
9565 (by connecting a different scan chain).
9566 @end quotation
9567 @end deffn
9568
9569 @deffn Command {flush_count}
9570 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
9571 This may be used for performance tuning.
9572
9573 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
9574 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
9575 not change with the amount of data which is written.
9576 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
9577 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
9578 instead of batching them into larger operations.
9579 @end deffn
9580
9581 @deffn Command {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
9582 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
9583 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
9584 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
9585 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
9586 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
9587
9588 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
9589 in that state.
9590 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
9591 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
9592 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
9593
9594 @quotation Note
9595 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
9596 register values, unlike data register values.
9597 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
9598 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
9599 @end quotation
9600 @end deffn
9601
9602 @deffn Command {jtag_reset} trst srst
9603 Set values of reset signals.
9604 The @var{trst} and @var{srst} parameter values may be
9605 @option{0}, indicating that reset is inactive (pulled or driven high),
9606 or @option{1}, indicating it is active (pulled or driven low).
9607 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
9608 to configure how the board and JTAG adapter treat these two
9609 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
9610 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
9611
9612 Note that TRST is specially handled.
9613 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
9614 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
9615 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
9616 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
9617 instead of the TRST signal.
9618 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
9619 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
9620 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
9621 with handlers for that event.
9622 @end deffn
9623
9624 @deffn Command {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
9625 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
9626 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
9627 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
9628 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
9629 Then, in a series of single state transitions
9630 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
9631 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
9632 The final state must also be stable.
9633 @end deffn
9634
9635 @deffn Command {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
9636 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
9637 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
9638 Instructions often need some time
9639 to execute before they take effect.
9640 @end deffn
9641
9642 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
9643 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
9644
9645 @deffn Command {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9646 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
9647 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
9648 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
9649 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
9650 @end deffn
9651
9652 @deffn Command {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9653 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
9654 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
9655 must also be enabled.
9656 Default is enabled.
9657 @end deffn
9658
9659 @section TAP state names
9660 @cindex TAP state names
9661
9662 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
9663 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
9664 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
9665 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
9666
9667 @itemize @bullet
9668 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
9669 acts as if TRST were pulsed
9670 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
9671 @item @b{DRSELECT}
9672 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
9673 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
9674 through the data register
9675 @item @b{DREXIT1}
9676 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
9677 for update or more shifting
9678 @item @b{DREXIT2}
9679 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
9680 @item @b{IRSELECT}
9681 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
9682 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
9683 through the instruction register
9684 @item @b{IREXIT1}
9685 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
9686 for update or more shifting
9687 @item @b{IREXIT2}
9688 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
9689 @end itemize
9690
9691 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
9692 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
9693 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
9694 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
9695
9696 @itemize @bullet
9697 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
9698 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
9699 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
9700 may not be as expected.
9701 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
9702 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
9703 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
9704 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
9705 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
9706 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
9707 @end itemize
9708
9709 @node Boundary Scan Commands
9710 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
9711
9712 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
9713 boundary scan based hardware testing.
9714 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
9715 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
9716
9717 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
9718 @cindex Serial Vector Format
9719 @cindex SVF
9720
9721 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
9722 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
9723 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
9724 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
9725
9726 @deffn Command {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
9727 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
9728 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
9729 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
9730
9731 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
9732 affect their semantics.
9733
9734 Command options:
9735 @itemize @minus
9736 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
9737 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
9738 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
9739 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
9740 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
9741 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
9742 on the real interface;
9743 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
9744 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
9745 errors.
9746 @end itemize
9747 @end deffn
9748
9749 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
9750 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
9751 @cindex XSVF
9752
9753 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
9754 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
9755 Xilinx devices.
9756 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
9757 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
9758
9759 @quotation Important
9760 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
9761 @end quotation
9762
9763 @deffn Command {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
9764 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
9765 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
9766 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
9767 that TAP.
9768 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
9769 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
9770 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
9771 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
9772 @end deffn
9773
9774 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
9775 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
9776 after building the software.
9777 You may find them useful:
9778
9779 @itemize
9780 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
9781 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
9782 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
9783 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
9784 @end itemize
9785
9786 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
9787 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
9788 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
9789 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
9790 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
9791 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
9792 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
9793
9794
9795 @node Utility Commands
9796 @chapter Utility Commands
9797 @cindex Utility Commands
9798
9799 @section RAM testing
9800 @cindex RAM testing
9801
9802 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
9803 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
9804 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
9805 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
9806 hardware problems.
9807
9808 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
9809 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
9810 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
9811 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
9812
9813 Load the memory testing functions with
9814
9815 @example
9816 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
9817 @end example
9818
9819 to get access to the following facilities:
9820
9821 @deffn Command {memTestDataBus} address
9822 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
9823 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
9824 @end deffn
9825
9826 @deffn Command {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
9827 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
9828 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
9829 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
9830 @end deffn
9831
9832 @deffn Command {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
9833 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
9834 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
9835 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
9836 @end deffn
9837
9838 @deffn Command {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
9839 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
9840 @end deffn
9841
9842 @section Firmware recovery helpers
9843 @cindex Firmware recovery
9844
9845 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
9846 devices recovery with JTAG.
9847
9848 For quickstart instructions run:
9849 @example
9850 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
9851 @end example
9852
9853 @node TFTP
9854 @chapter TFTP
9855 @cindex TFTP
9856 If OpenOCD runs on an embedded host (as ZY1000 does), then TFTP can
9857 be used to access files on PCs (either the developer's PC or some other PC).
9858
9859 The way this works on the ZY1000 is to prefix a filename by
9860 "/tftp/ip/" and append the TFTP path on the TFTP
9861 server (tftpd). For example,
9862
9863 @example
9864 load_image /tftp/10.0.0.96/c:\temp\abc.elf
9865 @end example
9866
9867 will load c:\temp\abc.elf from the developer pc (10.0.0.96) into memory as
9868 if the file was hosted on the embedded host.
9869
9870 In order to achieve decent performance, you must choose a TFTP server
9871 that supports a packet size bigger than the default packet size (512 bytes). There
9872 are numerous TFTP servers out there (free and commercial) and you will have to do
9873 a bit of googling to find something that fits your requirements.
9874
9875 @node GDB and OpenOCD
9876 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
9877 @cindex GDB
9878 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
9879 to debug remote targets.
9880 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
9881
9882 @itemize
9883 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
9884 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
9885 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
9886 as shown in this chapter.
9887 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
9888 that also will probably need to be configured.
9889 @end itemize
9890
9891 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
9892 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
9893 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
9894 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
9895 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
9896 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
9897
9898 @section Connecting to GDB
9899 @cindex Connecting to GDB
9900 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
9901 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
9902 errors, which has since been fixed; see
9903 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
9904
9905 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
9906
9907 @enumerate
9908 @item
9909 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
9910 @example
9911 target remote localhost:3333
9912 @end example
9913 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
9914
9915 It is also possible to use the GDB extended remote protocol as follows:
9916 @example
9917 target extended-remote localhost:3333
9918 @end example
9919 @item
9920 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
9921 @example
9922 target remote | openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
9923 @end example
9924 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
9925 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
9926 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
9927 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
9928 @end enumerate
9929
9930 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
9931 GDB command line.
9932
9933 @section Sample GDB session startup
9934
9935 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
9936 than they do when you're debugging locally.
9937 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
9938 small ARM program.
9939 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
9940 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
9941
9942 @example
9943 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
9944 (gdb) target remote localhost:3333
9945 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
9946 ...
9947 (gdb) monitor reset halt
9948 ...
9949 (gdb) load
9950 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
9951 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
9952 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
9953 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
9954 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
9955 (gdb) continue
9956 Continuing.
9957 ...
9958 @end example
9959
9960 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
9961 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
9962 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
9963 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
9964
9965 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
9966
9967 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
9968 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
9969 packet size and the device's memory map.
9970 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
9971 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
9972 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
9973
9974 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
9975 You may need to set those up by hand.
9976 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
9977 something like:
9978
9979 @example
9980 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
9981 @end example
9982
9983 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
9984
9985 @example
9986 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
9987 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
9988 @end example
9989
9990 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
9991 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
9992 do not have such restrictions.
9993
9994 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
9995 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
9996 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
9997 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
9998
9999 @section Programming using GDB
10000 @cindex Programming using GDB
10001 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
10002
10003 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
10004 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
10005 @example
10006 gdb_memory_map disable
10007 @end example
10008 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
10009 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
10010 working area.
10011
10012 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
10013 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
10014 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
10015 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
10016
10017 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
10018 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
10019
10020 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
10021 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
10022 @example
10023 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
10024 @end example
10025
10026 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
10027 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
10028
10029 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
10030 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
10031 will be used.
10032
10033 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
10034 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
10035 @example
10036 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
10037 @end example
10038 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
10039
10040 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
10041 can be used.
10042
10043 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10044 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10045 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
10046
10047 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
10048 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
10049 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
10050
10051 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
10052 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
10053 and GDB treats it as it were running.
10054 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
10055 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
10056 without any intrusion of the target process.
10057
10058 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
10059 Place following command after target configuration:
10060 @example
10061 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
10062 @end example
10063
10064 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
10065 switch off gdb_memory_map:
10066 @example
10067 gdb_memory_map disable
10068 @end example
10069
10070 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
10071 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
10072 @example
10073 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
10074 @end example
10075
10076 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
10077 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
10078
10079 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target remote ...} and inspect memory
10080 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
10081 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
10082 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
10083
10084 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
10085 previously shown varibles.
10086
10087 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
10088 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
10089 @cindex SMP
10090 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
10091 @itemize @bullet
10092 @item j - smp status request
10093 @item J - smp set request
10094 @end itemize
10095
10096 OpenOCD implements :
10097 @itemize @bullet
10098 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
10099 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
10100 @option{E01} for target not smp.
10101 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
10102 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
10103 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
10104 @end itemize
10105
10106 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
10107 @itemize @bullet
10108 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
10109 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
10110 @example
10111 set $_core 1
10112 #Jc01 packet is sent
10113 print $_core
10114 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
10115 @end example
10116
10117 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
10118 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
10119
10120 @example
10121 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
10122 define toggle0
10123 maint packet Jc0
10124 continue
10125 main packet Jc-1
10126 end
10127 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
10128 define toggle1
10129 maint packet Jc1
10130 continue
10131 main packet Jc-1
10132 end
10133 @end example
10134 @end itemize
10135
10136 @section RTOS Support
10137 @cindex RTOS Support
10138 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
10139
10140 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
10141 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
10142
10143 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
10144 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
10145 GDB commands.
10146
10147 @* An example setup is below:
10148
10149 @example
10150 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
10151 @end example
10152
10153 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
10154
10155 Currently supported rtos's include:
10156 @itemize @bullet
10157 @item @option{eCos}
10158 @item @option{ThreadX}
10159 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
10160 @item @option{linux}
10161 @item @option{ChibiOS}
10162 @item @option{embKernel}
10163 @item @option{mqx}
10164 @item @option{uCOS-III}
10165 @item @option{nuttx}
10166 @end itemize
10167
10168 @quotation Note
10169 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
10170 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
10171 @end quotation
10172
10173 @table @code
10174 @item eCos symbols
10175 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
10176 @item ThreadX symbols
10177 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
10178 @item FreeRTOS symbols
10179 @c The following is taken from recent texinfo to provide compatibility
10180 @c with ancient versions that do not support @raggedright
10181 @tex
10182 \begingroup
10183 \rightskip0pt plus2em \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em\relax
10184 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
10185 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
10186 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
10187 \par
10188 \endgroup
10189 @end tex
10190 @item linux symbols
10191 init_task.
10192 @item ChibiOS symbols
10193 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
10194 @item embKernel symbols
10195 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
10196 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
10197 @item mqx symbols
10198 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
10199 @item uC/OS-III symbols
10200 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty
10201 @item nuttx symbols
10202 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable
10203 @end table
10204
10205 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
10206 some, eg. FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III, extra steps must be taken.
10207
10208 These RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
10209 along with the project:
10210
10211 @table @code
10212 @item FreeRTOS
10213 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
10214 @item uC/OS-III
10215 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
10216 @end table
10217
10218 @node Tcl Scripting API
10219 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
10220 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
10221 @cindex Tcl scripts
10222 @section API rules
10223
10224 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
10225 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
10226 of state information as an argument to each proc.
10227
10228 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
10229 pair list and lists.
10230
10231 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
10232 list.
10233
10234 @example
10235 > set foo(me) Duane
10236 > set foo(you) Oyvind
10237 > set foo(mouse) Micky
10238 > set foo(duck) Donald
10239 @end example
10240
10241 If one does this:
10242
10243 @example
10244 > set foo
10245 @end example
10246
10247 The result is:
10248
10249 @example
10250 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
10251 @end example
10252
10253 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
10254
10255 @verbatim
10256 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
10257 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
10258 }
10259 @end verbatim
10260
10261 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
10262 should be passed in to the proc in question.
10263
10264 @section Internal low-level Commands
10265
10266 By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
10267 invoke directly.
10268
10269 Some low-level commands need to be prefixed with "ocd_"; e.g.
10270 @command{ocd_flash_banks}
10271 is the low-level API upon which @command{flash banks} is implemented.
10272
10273 @itemize @bullet
10274 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
10275
10276 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
10277 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
10278
10279 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
10280 @item @b{ocd_flash_banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
10281
10282 Return information about the flash banks
10283
10284 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
10285
10286 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
10287 its execution. Example:
10288
10289 @example
10290 > capture "reset init"
10291 @end example
10292
10293 @end itemize
10294
10295 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
10296 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
10297 called "flash_banks".
10298
10299 @section OpenOCD specific Global Variables
10300
10301 Real Tcl has ::tcl_platform(), and platform::identify, and many other
10302 variables. JimTCL, as implemented in OpenOCD creates $ocd_HOSTOS which
10303 holds one of the following values:
10304
10305 @itemize @bullet
10306 @item @b{cygwin} Running under Cygwin
10307 @item @b{darwin} Darwin (Mac-OS) is the underlying operating system.
10308 @item @b{freebsd} Running under FreeBSD
10309 @item @b{openbsd} Running under OpenBSD
10310 @item @b{netbsd} Running under NetBSD
10311 @item @b{linux} Linux is the underlying operating system
10312 @item @b{mingw32} Running under MingW32
10313 @item @b{winxx} Built using Microsoft Visual Studio
10314 @item @b{ecos} Running under eCos
10315 @item @b{other} Unknown, none of the above.
10316 @end itemize
10317
10318 Note: 'winxx' was chosen because today (March-2009) no distinction is made between Win32 and Win64.
10319
10320 @quotation Note
10321 We should add support for a variable like Tcl variable
10322 @code{tcl_platform(platform)}, it should be called
10323 @code{jim_platform} (because it
10324 is jim, not real tcl).
10325 @end quotation
10326
10327 @section Tcl RPC server
10328 @cindex RPC
10329
10330 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
10331 commands and receive the results.
10332
10333 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
10334 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
10335 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
10336 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
10337 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
10338
10339 Remember that most of the OpenOCD commands need to be prefixed with
10340 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. Sometimes you might also need the
10341 @command{capture} command.
10342
10343 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
10344
10345 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
10346 @cindex RPC Notifications
10347
10348 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
10349 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
10350
10351 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
10352 in the following format.
10353
10354 @verbatim
10355 type target_event event [event-name]
10356 type target_state state [state-name]
10357 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
10358 @end verbatim
10359
10360 @deffn {Command} tcl_notifications [on/off]
10361 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
10362 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
10363 Defaults to off.
10364
10365 @end deffn
10366
10367 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
10368 @cindex RPC trace output
10369
10370 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
10371 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
10372
10373 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
10374
10375 @verbatim
10376 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
10377 @end verbatim
10378
10379 @deffn {Command} tcl_trace [on/off]
10380 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
10381 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
10382 Defaults to off.
10383
10384 See an example application here:
10385 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
10386
10387 @end deffn
10388
10389 @node FAQ
10390 @chapter FAQ
10391 @cindex faq
10392 @enumerate
10393 @anchor{faqrtck}
10394 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
10395 @cindex RTCK
10396 @cindex adaptive clocking
10397 @*
10398
10399 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
10400 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
10401 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
10402 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
10403
10404 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
10405 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
10406 for example. There are 2 basic options:
10407 @enumerate
10408 @item
10409 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
10410 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
10411 @item
10412 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
10413 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
10414 @end enumerate
10415
10416 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
10417 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
10418 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
10419 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
10420 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
10421 power).
10422
10423 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
10424 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
10425 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
10426 ARM926 scenario).
10427 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
10428 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
10429 JTAG can use a faster clock.
10430
10431 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
10432 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
10433 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
10434 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
10435
10436 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
10437
10438 In order to make use of this,
10439 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
10440 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
10441
10442 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
10443 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
10444 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
10445 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
10446 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
10447
10448 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
10449 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
10450 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
10451 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
10452
10453 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
10454 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
10455 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
10456 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
10457 with a CPLD.
10458 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
10459 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
10460 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
10461 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
10462 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
10463 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
10464
10465 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
10466
10467 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
10468
10469 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
10470 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
10471 depending on the chips on your board.
10472 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
10473 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
10474 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
10475
10476 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
10477 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
10478 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
10479
10480 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
10481 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
10482 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
10483 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
10484
10485 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
10486 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
10487 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
10488 this way.
10489
10490 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
10491 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
10492 clock rate.
10493 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
10494 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
10495 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
10496
10497 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
10498
10499 @example
10500 # Example: 1.234MHz
10501 adapter_khz 1234
10502 @end example
10503
10504
10505 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
10506
10507 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
10508 around Windows filenames.
10509
10510 @example
10511 > echo \a
10512
10513 > echo @{\a@}
10514 \a
10515 > echo "\a"
10516
10517 >
10518 @end example
10519
10520
10521 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
10522
10523 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
10524 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
10525 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
10526
10527 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
10528 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
10529 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
10530
10531 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
10532 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
10533 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
10534
10535 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
10536
10537 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
10538 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
10539 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
10540 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
10541
10542 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
10543 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
10544 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
10545
10546 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
10547 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
10548
10549 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
10550 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
10551 memory read caused data abort".
10552
10553 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
10554 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
10555 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
10556 be done, feel free to add this here.
10557
10558 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
10559 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
10560 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
10561 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
10562 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
10563 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
10564 gracefully stops.
10565
10566 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
10567 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
10568 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
10569
10570 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
10571 often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
10572 bytes. Painful...
10573
10574
10575 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
10576 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
10577
10578 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
10579 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{jtag_reset
10580 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
10581 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
10582 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
10583 reset, everything else should work fine.
10584
10585 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
10586 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
10587 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
10588 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
10589
10590 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
10591 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
10592 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
10593 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
10594
10595 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
10596
10597 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
10598 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
10599 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
10600
10601 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
10602 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
10603
10604 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
10605 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
10606 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
10607 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
10608 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
10609 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
10610 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
10611 clock frequency?
10612
10613 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
10614 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
10615 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
10616 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
10617 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
10618
10619 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
10620
10621 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
10622 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
10623 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
10624 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
10625 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
10626 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
10627 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
10628
10629 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
10630
10631 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
10632 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
10633 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
10634 up DRAM and loading it with code.
10635
10636 @anchor{faqtaporder}
10637 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
10638 particular order?
10639
10640 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
10641 the same order used by the hardware.
10642
10643 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
10644 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
10645 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
10646 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
10647 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
10648 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
10649
10650 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
10651 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
10652 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
10653 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
10654
10655 @itemize @bullet
10656 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
10657 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
10658 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
10659 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
10660 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
10661 @end itemize
10662
10663 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
10664
10665 @itemize @bullet
10666 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
10667 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
10668 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
10669 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
10670 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
10671 @end itemize
10672
10673
10674 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
10675 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
10676 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
10677
10678 TODO.
10679
10680 @end enumerate
10681
10682 @node Tcl Crash Course
10683 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
10684 @cindex Tcl
10685
10686 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
10687 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
10688 how the Tcl scripts work.
10689
10690 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
10691 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
10692 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
10693 OpenOCD.
10694
10695 @section Tcl Rule #1
10696 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
10697 @enumerate
10698 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
10699 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
10700 @end enumerate
10701
10702 The Tcl equal is this:
10703
10704 @enumerate
10705 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
10706 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
10707 @end enumerate
10708
10709 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
10710 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
10711
10712 @section Tcl Rule #1b
10713 There is a second pair of rules.
10714 @enumerate
10715 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
10716 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
10717 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
10718 in Tcl.
10719 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
10720 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
10721 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
10722 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
10723 @end enumerate
10724
10725 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
10726 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
10727 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
10728 Everything is a string}
10729
10730 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
10731 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
10732 difference is subtle.
10733 @enumerate
10734 @item Parse Time
10735 @item Evaluation Time
10736 @end enumerate
10737
10738 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
10739 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
10740 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
10741
10742 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
10743 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
10744 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
10745 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
10746
10747 @itemize @bullet
10748 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
10749 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
10750 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
10751 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
10752 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
10753 @example
10754 # bash example
10755 X=`date`
10756 echo "The Date is: $X"
10757 # Tcl example
10758 set X [date]
10759 puts "The Date is: $X"
10760 @end example
10761 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
10762 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
10763 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
10764 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
10765 is a string}
10766 @example
10767 set x "Dinner"
10768 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
10769 @end example
10770 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
10771 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
10772 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
10773 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
10774 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
10775 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
10776 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
10777 @end itemize
10778
10779 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
10780
10781 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
10782
10783 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
10784
10785 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
10786 the normal way.
10787
10788 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
10789 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
10790 line is immediately executed.
10791
10792 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
10793 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
10794
10795 @subsection Command Execution
10796
10797 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
10798 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
10799 control flow operators.
10800
10801 Commands are executed like this:
10802
10803 @enumerate
10804 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
10805 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
10806 @item Repeat until End Of File.
10807 @end enumerate
10808
10809 It sort of works like this:
10810 @example
10811 for(;;)@{
10812 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
10813
10814 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
10815
10816 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
10817 @}
10818 @end example
10819
10820 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
10821 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
10822 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
10823 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
10824 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
10825 ``LookupCommand()''
10826
10827 @subsection The FOR command
10828
10829 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
10830 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
10831 command just like any other command.
10832
10833 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
10834 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
10835 are:
10836
10837 @enumerate 0
10838 @item The ascii text 'for'
10839 @item The start text
10840 @item The test expression
10841 @item The next text
10842 @item The body text
10843 @end enumerate
10844
10845 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
10846 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
10847 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
10848 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
10849
10850 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
10851 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
10852
10853 @example
10854 int
10855 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
10856 int *argc,
10857 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
10858 @end example
10859
10860 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
10861 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
10862 still operates in the same basic way.
10863
10864 @subsection FOR command implementation
10865
10866 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
10867 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
10868
10869 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
10870
10871 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
10872
10873 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
10874 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
10875 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
10876
10877 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
10878 expression and returns a value.
10879
10880 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
10881 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
10882 @example
10883 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
10884
10885 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
10886
10887 int
10888 MyForCommand( void *interp,
10889 int argc,
10890 char **argv )
10891 @{
10892 if( argc != 5 )@{
10893 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
10894 return ERROR;
10895 @}
10896
10897 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
10898
10899 // Execute the start statement.
10900 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
10901
10902 // Top of loop test
10903 for(;;)@{
10904 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
10905 if( i == 0 )
10906 break;
10907
10908 // Execute the body
10909 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
10910
10911 // Execute the LOOP part
10912 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
10913 @}
10914
10915 // Return no error
10916 SetResult( interp, "" );
10917 return SUCCESS;
10918 @}
10919 @end example
10920
10921 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
10922 in the same basic way.
10923
10924 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
10925
10926 @subsection source and find commands
10927 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
10928 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
10929 @*Remember the parsing rules
10930 @enumerate
10931 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
10932 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
10933 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
10934 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
10935 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
10936 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
10937 That character begins Tcl comments.)
10938 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
10939 it reads a file and executes as a script.
10940 @end enumerate
10941 @subsection format command
10942 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
10943 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
10944 @b{sprintf()}.
10945 @b{Example}
10946 @example
10947 set x 6
10948 set y 7
10949 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
10950 @end example
10951 @enumerate
10952 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
10953 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
10954 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
10955 @* Refer to Rule #1
10956 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
10957 @* Refer to Rule #1.
10958 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
10959 @end enumerate
10960 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
10961 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
10962 @example
10963 #1 Good
10964 proc someproc @{@} @{
10965 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
10966 @}
10967 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
10968 #2 Good - no variables
10969 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
10970 #3 Good Curly Braces
10971 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
10972 puts "Time: [date]"
10973 @}
10974 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
10975 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
10976 @end example
10977 @enumerate
10978 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
10979 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
10980 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
10981 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
10982 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
10983 command.
10984 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
10985 @*There are 4 examples:
10986 @enumerate
10987 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
10988 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
10989 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
10990 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
10991 @end enumerate
10992
10993 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
10994 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
10995 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
10996
10997 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
10998 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
10999 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
11000 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
11001 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
11002 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
11003 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
11004 @end enumerate
11005 @subsection Global Variables
11006 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
11007 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
11008 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
11009 @example
11010 proc myproc @{ @} @{
11011 set y 0 #Local variable Y
11012 global x #Global variable X
11013 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
11014 @}
11015 @end example
11016 @section Other Tcl Hacks
11017 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
11018 @example
11019 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
11020 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
11021 # Create var name
11022 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
11023 # Make it a global
11024 global $vn
11025 # Set it.
11026 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
11027 @}
11028 @end example
11029 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
11030 @example
11031 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
11032 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
11033 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
11034 @}
11035 @end example
11036
11037 @include fdl.texi
11038
11039 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
11040 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
11041 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
11042 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
11043 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
11044 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
11045
11046 @printindex cp
11047
11048 @node Command and Driver Index
11049 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
11050 @printindex fn
11051
11052 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)